*** empty log message ***
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
6d2ebf8b
SS
130
131* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134* Altering:: Altering execution
135* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 140* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
141* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
142* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 143* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
144
145* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
146* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
147
148* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
149* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
150* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
151* Index:: Index
152@end menu
153
b9deaee7 154@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
155
156@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
157
158@ifhtml
159@node Top
160
161@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
162
163This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
164
b37052ae 165This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
166@value{GDBVN}.
167
168Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
169
c906108c
SS
170@menu
171* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 172* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
173
174* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
175* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
176* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
177* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
178* Stack:: Examining the stack
179* Source:: Examining source files
180* Data:: Examining data
496e6bc3 181* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
c906108c 182
7a292a7a 183* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
184
185* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
186* Altering:: Altering execution
187* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
188* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 189* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
190* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
191* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
496e6bc3 192* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
c906108c 193* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 194* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
496e6bc3 195* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
c906108c
SS
196
197* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 198* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
199
200* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
201* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
202* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
203* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
204@end menu
205
6d2ebf8b
SS
206@end ifhtml
207
449f3b6c
AC
208@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
209@iftex
210@contents
211@end iftex
212
6d2ebf8b 213@node Summary
c906108c
SS
214@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
215
216The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
217going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
218program was doing at the moment it crashed.
219
220@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
221these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
222
223@itemize @bullet
224@item
225Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
226
227@item
228Make your program stop on specified conditions.
229
230@item
231Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
232
233@item
234Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
235effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
236@end itemize
237
cce74817 238You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 239For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
240For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
241
cce74817
JM
242@cindex Chill
243@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 244Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 245see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 246
cce74817
JM
247@cindex Pascal
248Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
249nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
250entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
251syntax.
c906108c 252
c906108c
SS
253@cindex Fortran
254@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 255it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 256underscore.
c906108c 257
c906108c
SS
258@menu
259* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
260* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
261@end menu
262
6d2ebf8b 263@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
264@unnumberedsec Free software
265
5d161b24 266@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
267General Public License
268(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
269program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
270freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
271the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
272Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
273Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
274
275Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
276you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
277from anyone else.
278
6d2ebf8b 279@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
280@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
281
282Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
283other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
284development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
285of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
286to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
287file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
288blow-by-blow account.
289
290Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
291
292@quotation
293@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
294or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
295omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
296@end quotation
297
298So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
299particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
300releases:
b37052ae 301Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
302Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
303Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
304Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
305Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
306Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
307John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
308Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
309and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
310
311Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
312Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
313
b37052ae
EZ
314Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
315in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
316Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
317demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
318much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 319
b37052ae 320@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
321object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
322Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
323
324David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
325the original support for encapsulated COFF.
326
96c405b3 327Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
328
329Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
330Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
331support.
332Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
333Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
334Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
335David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
336Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
337Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
338Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
339Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
340Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
341Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
342Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
343Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
344Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
345Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
346Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
347
348Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
349
350Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
351libraries.
352
353Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
354about several machine instruction sets.
355
356Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
357remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
358contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
359and RDI targets, respectively.
360
361Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
362command-line editing and command history.
363
7a292a7a
SS
364Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
365Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 366
5d161b24 367Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 368He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 369symbols.
c906108c
SS
370
371Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
372Super-H processors.
373
374NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
375
376Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
377
378Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
379
380Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
381
96a2c332 382Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
383
384Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
385watchpoints.
386
387Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
388
389Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
390
391Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 392nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
393
394The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
395support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 396(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
397compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
398John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
399Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
400information in this manual.
401
b37052ae
EZ
402DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
403Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
404
96a2c332
SS
405Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
406development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
407fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
408Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
409Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
410Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
411Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
412addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
413JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
414Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
415Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
416Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
417Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
418Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
419Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
420
421
6d2ebf8b 422@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
423@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
424
425You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
426However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
427debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
428
429@iftex
430In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
431to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
432@end iftex
433
434@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
435@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
436
437One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
438processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
439quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
440definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
441session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
442then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
443same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
444@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
445procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
446
447@smallexample
448$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
449$ @b{./m4}
450@b{define(foo,0000)}
451
452@b{foo}
4530000
454@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
455
456@b{bar}
4570000
458@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
459
460@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
461@b{baz}
462@b{C-d}
463m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
464@end smallexample
465
466@noindent
467Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
468
c906108c
SS
469@smallexample
470$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
471@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
472@c FIXME... format to come out better.
473@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 474 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 475 the conditions.
5d161b24 476There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
477 for details.
478
479@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
480(@value{GDBP})
481@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
482
483@noindent
484@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
485rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
486We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
487that examples fit in this manual.
488
489@smallexample
490(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
491@end smallexample
492
493@noindent
494We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
495Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
496@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
497@code{break} command.
498
499@smallexample
500(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
501Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
502@end smallexample
503
504@noindent
505Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
506control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
507subroutine, the program runs as usual:
508
509@smallexample
510(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
511Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
512@b{define(foo,0000)}
513
514@b{foo}
5150000
516@end smallexample
517
518@noindent
519To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
520suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
521context where it stops.
522
523@smallexample
524@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
525
5d161b24 526Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
527 at builtin.c:879
528879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
529@end smallexample
530
531@noindent
532Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
533the next line of the current function.
534
535@smallexample
536(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
537882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
538 : nil,
539@end smallexample
540
541@noindent
542@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
543by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
544@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
545subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
546
547@smallexample
548(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
549set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
550 at input.c:530
551530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
552@end smallexample
553
554@noindent
555The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
556suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
557shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
558command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
559in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
560stack frame for each active subroutine.
561
562@smallexample
563(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
564#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
565 at input.c:530
5d161b24 566#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
567 at builtin.c:882
568#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
569#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
570 at macro.c:71
571#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
572#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
573@end smallexample
574
575@noindent
576We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
577times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
578falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
579
580@smallexample
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5820x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
583(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5840x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
585def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
586(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
588 : xstrdup(rq);
589(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
590538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
591@end smallexample
592
593@noindent
594The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
595@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
596and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
597(@code{print}) to see their values.
598
599@smallexample
600(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
601$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
602(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
603$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
604@end smallexample
605
606@noindent
607@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
608To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
609surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
610
611@smallexample
612(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
613533 xfree(rquote);
614534
615535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
616 : xstrdup (lq);
617536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
618 : xstrdup (rq);
619537
620538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
621539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
622540 @}
623541
624542 void
625@end smallexample
626
627@noindent
628Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
629@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
630
631@smallexample
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
633539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
635540 @}
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
637$3 = 9
638(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
639$4 = 7
640@end smallexample
641
642@noindent
643That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
644@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
645@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
646the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
647any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
648assignments.
649
650@smallexample
651(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
652$5 = 7
653(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
654$6 = 9
655@end smallexample
656
657@noindent
658Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
659@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
660executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
661example that caused trouble initially:
662
663@smallexample
664(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
665Continuing.
666
667@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
668
669baz
6700000
671@end smallexample
672
673@noindent
674Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
675problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
676lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
677
678@smallexample
679@b{C-d}
680Program exited normally.
681@end smallexample
682
683@noindent
684The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
685indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
686session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
687
688@smallexample
689(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
690@end smallexample
c906108c 691
6d2ebf8b 692@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
693@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
694
695This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 696The essentials are:
c906108c 697@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 698@item
53a5351d 699type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 700@item
c906108c
SS
701type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
702@end itemize
703
704@menu
705* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
706* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
707* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
708@end menu
709
6d2ebf8b 710@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
711@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
712
c906108c
SS
713Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
714@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
715
716You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
717to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
718
c906108c
SS
719The command-line options described here are designed
720to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 721options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
722
723The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
724specifying an executable program:
725
726@example
727@value{GDBP} @var{program}
728@end example
729
c906108c
SS
730@noindent
731You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
732specified:
733
734@example
735@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
736@end example
737
738You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
739to debug a running process:
740
741@example
742@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
743@end example
744
745@noindent
746would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
747named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
748
c906108c 749Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
750complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
751debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
752``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
753will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 754
96a2c332 755You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
756@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
757
758@smallexample
759@value{GDBP} -silent
760@end smallexample
761
762@noindent
763You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
764options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
765
766@noindent
767Type
768
769@example
770@value{GDBP} -help
771@end example
772
773@noindent
774to display all available options and briefly describe their use
775(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
776
777All options and command line arguments you give are processed
778in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
779@samp{-x} option is used.
780
781
782@menu
c906108c
SS
783* File Options:: Choosing files
784* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
785@end menu
786
6d2ebf8b 787@node File Options
c906108c
SS
788@subsection Choosing files
789
2df3850c 790When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
791specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
792the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
793@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
794that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
795@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
796that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
797the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
798
799If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
800such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
801argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
802
803Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
804following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
805them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
806(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
807than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
808
d700128c
EZ
809@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
810@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
811@c it.
812
c906108c
SS
813@table @code
814@item -symbols @var{file}
815@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
816@cindex @code{--symbols}
817@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
818Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
819
820@item -exec @var{file}
821@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
822@cindex @code{--exec}
823@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
824Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
825and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
826
827@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 828@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
829Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
830file.
831
c906108c
SS
832@item -core @var{file}
833@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
834@cindex @code{--core}
835@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
836Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
837
838@item -c @var{number}
839Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
840(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
841case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
842
843@item -command @var{file}
844@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
845@cindex @code{--command}
846@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
847Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
848Files,, Command files}.
849
850@item -directory @var{directory}
851@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
852@cindex @code{--directory}
853@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
854Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
855
c906108c
SS
856@item -m
857@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
858@cindex @code{--mapped}
859@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
860@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
861supported on all systems.}@*
862If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 863system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
864to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
865program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 866called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
867Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
868and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
869the symbol table from the executable program.
870
871The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
872is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
873table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 874
c906108c
SS
875@item -r
876@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
877@cindex @code{--readnow}
878@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
879Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
880the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
881This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 882
c906108c
SS
883@end table
884
2df3850c 885You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 886order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
887information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
888on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
889but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
890
891@example
2df3850c 892gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 893@end example
c906108c 894
6d2ebf8b 895@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
896@subsection Choosing modes
897
898You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
899batch mode or quiet mode.
900
901@table @code
902@item -nx
903@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
904@cindex @code{--nx}
905@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
906Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
907called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
908@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
909options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
910files}.
c906108c
SS
911
912@item -quiet
d700128c 913@itemx -silent
c906108c 914@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
915@cindex @code{--quiet}
916@cindex @code{--silent}
917@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
918``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
919messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
920
921@item -batch
d700128c 922@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
923Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
924command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
925initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
926nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
927in the command files.
928
2df3850c
JM
929Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
930example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
931make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
932
933@example
934Program exited normally.
935@end example
936
937@noindent
2df3850c
JM
938(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
939@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
940mode.
941
942@item -nowindows
943@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
944@cindex @code{--nowindows}
945@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 946``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 947(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
948interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
949
950@item -windows
951@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
952@cindex @code{--windows}
953@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
954If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
955used if possible.
c906108c
SS
956
957@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 958@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
959Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
960instead of the current directory.
961
c906108c
SS
962@item -fullname
963@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
964@cindex @code{--fullname}
965@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
966@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
967subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
968number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
969displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
970recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
971the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
972and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
973@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
974frame.
c906108c 975
d700128c
EZ
976@item -epoch
977@cindex @code{--epoch}
978The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
979@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
980routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
981separate window.
982
983@item -annotate @var{level}
984@cindex @code{--annotate}
985This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
986effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
987(@pxref{Annotations}).
988Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
989together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
990types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
991@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
992maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
993
994@item -async
995@cindex @code{--async}
996Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
997@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
998special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
999commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1000run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1001MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1002suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1003control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1004(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1005operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1006yet.)
1007@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1008@c should be removed.
1009
1010When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1011uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1012@samp{-noasync} option.
1013
1014@item -noasync
1015@cindex @code{--noasync}
1016Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1017
2df3850c
JM
1018@item -baud @var{bps}
1019@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1020@cindex @code{--baud}
1021@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1022Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1023interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1024
1025@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1026@itemx -t @var{device}
1027@cindex @code{--tty}
1028@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1029Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1030@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1031
53a5351d 1032@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1033@item -tui
1034@cindex @code{--tui}
1035Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1036The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1037showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1038(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1039Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1040(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1041
1042@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1043@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1044@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1045@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1046@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1047@c systems.
1048
d700128c
EZ
1049@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1050@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1051Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1052program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1053communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1054
1055@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1056@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1057@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1058@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1059
1060@item -write
1061@cindex @code{--write}
1062Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1063is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1064(@pxref{Patching}).
1065
1066@item -statistics
1067@cindex @code{--statistics}
1068This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1069memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1070
1071@item -version
1072@cindex @code{--version}
1073This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1074no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1075
c906108c
SS
1076@end table
1077
6d2ebf8b 1078@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1079@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1080@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1081@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1082
1083@table @code
1084@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1085@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1086@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1087@itemx q
1088To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1089@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1090do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1091otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1092error code.
c906108c
SS
1093@end table
1094
1095@cindex interrupt
1096An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1097terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1098returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1099character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1100until a time when it is safe.
1101
c906108c
SS
1102If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1103device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1104(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1105
6d2ebf8b 1106@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1107@section Shell commands
1108
1109If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1110debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1111just use the @code{shell} command.
1112
1113@table @code
1114@kindex shell
1115@cindex shell escape
1116@item shell @var{command string}
1117Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1118If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1119shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1120(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1121@end table
1122
1123The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1124You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1125@value{GDBN}:
1126
1127@table @code
1128@kindex make
1129@cindex calling make
1130@item make @var{make-args}
1131Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1132arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1133@end table
1134
6d2ebf8b 1135@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1136@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1137
1138You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1139name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1140@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1141key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1142show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1143
1144@menu
1145* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1146* Completion:: Command completion
1147* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1148@end menu
1149
6d2ebf8b 1150@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1151@section Command syntax
1152
1153A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1154how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1155arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1156command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1157step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1158with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1159
1160@cindex abbreviation
1161@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1162unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1163documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1164abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1165equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1166names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1167arguments to the @code{help} command.
1168
1169@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1170@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1171A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1172repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1173will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1174repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1175repeat.
1176
1177The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1178@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1179exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1180
1181@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1182output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1183(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1184@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1185repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1186
41afff9a 1187@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1188@cindex comment
1189Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1190nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1191Files,,Command files}).
1192
6d2ebf8b 1193@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1194@section Command completion
1195
1196@cindex completion
1197@cindex word completion
1198@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1199only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1200are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1201commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1202
1203Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1204of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1205word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1206enter it). For example, if you type
1207
1208@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1209@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1210@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1211@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1212@example
1213(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1214@end example
1215
1216@noindent
1217@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1218the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1219
1220@example
1221(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1222@end example
1223
1224@noindent
1225You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1226breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1227@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1228were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1229might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1230to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1231
1232If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1233@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1234characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1235@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1236example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1237begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1238just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1239function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1240example:
1241
1242@example
1243(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1244@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1245make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1246make_abs_section make_function_type
1247make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1248make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1249make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1250(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1251@end example
1252
1253@noindent
1254After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1255partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1256command.
1257
1258If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1259can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1260means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1261key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1262one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1263
1264@cindex quotes in commands
1265@cindex completion of quoted strings
1266Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1267parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1268its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1269situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1270@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1271
c906108c 1272The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1273name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1274overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1275by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1276may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1277that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1278that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1279word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1280@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1281@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1282when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1283
1284@example
96a2c332 1285(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1286bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1287(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1288@end example
1289
1290In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1291quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1292completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1293place:
1294
1295@example
1296(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1297@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1298(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1299@end example
1300
1301@noindent
1302In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1303you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1304completion on an overloaded symbol.
1305
d4f3574e 1306For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1307expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1308overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1309see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1310
1311
6d2ebf8b 1312@node Help
c906108c
SS
1313@section Getting help
1314@cindex online documentation
1315@kindex help
1316
5d161b24 1317You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1318using the command @code{help}.
1319
1320@table @code
41afff9a 1321@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1322@item help
1323@itemx h
1324You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1325display a short list of named classes of commands:
1326
1327@smallexample
1328(@value{GDBP}) help
1329List of classes of commands:
1330
2df3850c 1331aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1332breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1333data -- Examining data
c906108c 1334files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1335internals -- Maintenance commands
1336obscure -- Obscure features
1337running -- Running the program
1338stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1339status -- Status inquiries
1340support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1341tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1342 stopping the program
c906108c 1343user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1344
5d161b24 1345Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1346commands in that class.
5d161b24 1347Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1348documentation.
1349Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1350(@value{GDBP})
1351@end smallexample
96a2c332 1352@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1353
1354@item help @var{class}
1355Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1356list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1357help display for the class @code{status}:
1358
1359@smallexample
1360(@value{GDBP}) help status
1361Status inquiries.
1362
1363List of commands:
1364
1365@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1366@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1367info -- Generic command for showing things
1368 about the program being debugged
1369show -- Generic command for showing things
1370 about the debugger
c906108c 1371
5d161b24 1372Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1373documentation.
1374Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1375(@value{GDBP})
1376@end smallexample
1377
1378@item help @var{command}
1379With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1380short paragraph on how to use that command.
1381
6837a0a2
DB
1382@kindex apropos
1383@item apropos @var{args}
1384The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1385commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1386@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1387
1388@smallexample
1389apropos reload
1390@end smallexample
1391
b37052ae
EZ
1392@noindent
1393results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1394
1395@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1396@c @group
1397set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1398 multiple times in one run
1399show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1400 multiple times in one run
1401@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1402@end smallexample
1403
c906108c
SS
1404@kindex complete
1405@item complete @var{args}
1406The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1407for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1408command you want completed. For example:
1409
1410@smallexample
1411complete i
1412@end smallexample
1413
1414@noindent results in:
1415
1416@smallexample
1417@group
2df3850c
JM
1418if
1419ignore
c906108c
SS
1420info
1421inspect
c906108c
SS
1422@end group
1423@end smallexample
1424
1425@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1426@end table
1427
1428In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1429and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1430of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1431manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1432under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1433all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1434
1435@c @group
1436@table @code
1437@kindex info
41afff9a 1438@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1439@item info
1440This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1441program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1442with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1443registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1444You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1445@w{@code{help info}}.
1446
1447@kindex set
1448@item set
5d161b24 1449You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1450@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1451@code{set prompt $}.
1452
1453@kindex show
1454@item show
5d161b24 1455In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1456@value{GDBN} itself.
1457You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1458related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1459system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1460which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1461
1462@kindex info set
1463To display all the settable parameters and their current
1464values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1465@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1466@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1467@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1468@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1469@end table
1470@c @end group
1471
1472Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1473exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1474
1475@table @code
1476@kindex show version
1477@cindex version number
1478@item show version
1479Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1480information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1481@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1482version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1483commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1484system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1485variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1486The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1487@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1488
1489@kindex show copying
1490@item show copying
1491Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1492
1493@kindex show warranty
1494@item show warranty
2df3850c 1495Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1496if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1497
c906108c
SS
1498@end table
1499
6d2ebf8b 1500@node Running
c906108c
SS
1501@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1502
1503When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1504debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1505
1506You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1507of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1508your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1509kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1510
1511@menu
1512* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1513* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1514* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1515* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1516
1517* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1518* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1519* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1520* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1521
1522* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1523* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1524@end menu
1525
6d2ebf8b 1526@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1527@section Compiling for debugging
1528
1529In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1530debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1531is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1532variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1533and addresses in the executable code.
1534
1535To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1536the compiler.
1537
1538Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1539options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1540executables containing debugging information.
1541
53a5351d
JM
1542@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1543without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1544recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1545program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1546in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1547
1548@cindex optimized code, debugging
1549@cindex debugging optimized code
1550When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1551optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1552really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1553exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1554variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1555variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1556
1557Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1558@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1559doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1560please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1561
1562Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1563@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1564format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1565
1566@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1567@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1568@section Starting your program
1569@cindex starting
1570@cindex running
1571
1572@table @code
1573@kindex run
41afff9a 1574@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1575@item run
1576@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1577Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1578You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1579argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1580@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1581(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1582
1583@end table
1584
c906108c
SS
1585If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1586supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1587that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1588@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1589
1590The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1591receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1592information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1593can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1594your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1595divided into four categories:
1596
1597@table @asis
1598@item The @emph{arguments.}
1599Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1600@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1601is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1602(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1603the arguments.
1604In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1605@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1606@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1607
1608@item The @emph{environment.}
1609Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1610use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1611environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1612your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1613
1614@item The @emph{working directory.}
1615Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1616the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1617@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1618
1619@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1620Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1621standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1622in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1623set a different device for your program.
1624@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1625
1626@cindex pipes
1627@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1628pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1629program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1630wrong program.
1631@end table
c906108c
SS
1632
1633When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1634immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1635of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1636stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1637or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1638
1639If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1640time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1641table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1642your current breakpoints.
1643
6d2ebf8b 1644@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1645@section Your program's arguments
1646
1647@cindex arguments (to your program)
1648The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1649@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1650They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1651performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1652@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1653@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1654the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1655
1656On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1657@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1658calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1659the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1660
1661@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1662@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1663
c906108c 1664@table @code
41afff9a 1665@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1666@item set args
1667Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1668@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1669with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1670using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1671it again without arguments.
1672
1673@kindex show args
1674@item show args
1675Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1676@end table
1677
6d2ebf8b 1678@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1679@section Your program's environment
1680
1681@cindex environment (of your program)
1682The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1683their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1684your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1685path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1686the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1687debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1688environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1689
1690@table @code
1691@kindex path
1692@item path @var{directory}
1693Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1694(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1695The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1696You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1697system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1698MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1699is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1700
1701You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1702working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1703use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1704@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1705@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1706@var{directory} to the search path.
1707@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1708@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1709
1710@kindex show paths
1711@item show paths
1712Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1713environment variable).
1714
1715@kindex show environment
1716@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1717Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1718your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1719print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1720your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1721
1722@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1723@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1724Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1725changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1726be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1727any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1728parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1729null value.
1730@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1731@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1732
1733For example, this command:
1734
1735@example
1736set env USER = foo
1737@end example
1738
1739@noindent
d4f3574e 1740tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1741@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1742are not actually required.)
1743
1744@kindex unset environment
1745@item unset environment @var{varname}
1746Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1747program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1748@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1749rather than assigning it an empty value.
1750@end table
1751
d4f3574e
SS
1752@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1753the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1754by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1755@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1756that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1757@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1758your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1759files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1760@file{.profile}.
1761
6d2ebf8b 1762@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1763@section Your program's working directory
1764
1765@cindex working directory (of your program)
1766Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1767working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1768The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1769from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1770working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1771
1772The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1773that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1774specify files}.
1775
1776@table @code
1777@kindex cd
1778@item cd @var{directory}
1779Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1780
1781@kindex pwd
1782@item pwd
1783Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1784@end table
1785
6d2ebf8b 1786@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1787@section Your program's input and output
1788
1789@cindex redirection
1790@cindex i/o
1791@cindex terminal
1792By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1793the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1794to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1795modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1796running your program.
1797
1798@table @code
1799@kindex info terminal
1800@item info terminal
1801Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1802program is using.
1803@end table
1804
1805You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1806redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1807
1808@example
1809run > outfile
1810@end example
1811
1812@noindent
1813starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1814
1815@kindex tty
1816@cindex controlling terminal
1817Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1818with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1819argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1820commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1821process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1822
1823@example
1824tty /dev/ttyb
1825@end example
1826
1827@noindent
1828directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1829default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1830that as their controlling terminal.
1831
1832An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1833effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1834terminal.
1835
1836When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1837command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1838for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1839
6d2ebf8b 1840@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1841@section Debugging an already-running process
1842@kindex attach
1843@cindex attach
1844
1845@table @code
1846@item attach @var{process-id}
1847This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1848outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1849targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1850find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1851or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1852
1853@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1854executing the command.
1855@end table
1856
1857To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1858which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1859programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1860also have permission to send the process a signal.
1861
1862When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1863the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1864the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1865(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1866the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1867Specify Files}.
1868
1869The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1870process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1871with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1872you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1873can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1874process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1875attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1876
1877@table @code
1878@kindex detach
1879@item detach
1880When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1881@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1882the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1883that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1884are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1885@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1886executing the command.
1887@end table
1888
1889If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1890attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1891for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1892control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1893confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1894messages}).
1895
6d2ebf8b 1896@node Kill Process
c906108c 1897@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1898
1899@table @code
1900@kindex kill
1901@item kill
1902Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1903@end table
1904
1905This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1906running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1907is running.
1908
1909On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1910while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1911@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1912outside the debugger.
1913
1914The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1915relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1916executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1917next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1918reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1919breakpoint settings).
1920
6d2ebf8b 1921@node Threads
c906108c 1922@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1923
1924@cindex threads of execution
1925@cindex multiple threads
1926@cindex switching threads
1927In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1928may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1929of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1930the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1931that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1932modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1933registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1934
1935@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1936programs:
1937
1938@itemize @bullet
1939@item automatic notification of new threads
1940@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1941@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1942@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1943a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1944@item thread-specific breakpoints
1945@end itemize
1946
c906108c
SS
1947@quotation
1948@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1949@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1950If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1951effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1952from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1953like this:
1954
1955@smallexample
1956(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1957(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1958Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1959see the IDs of currently known threads.
1960@end smallexample
1961@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1962@c doesn't support threads"?
1963@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1964
1965@cindex focus of debugging
1966@cindex current thread
1967The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1968threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1969control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1970This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1971program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1972
41afff9a 1973@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1974@cindex thread identifier (system)
1975@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1976@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1977@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1978Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1979the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1980form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1981whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1982LynxOS, you might see
1983
1984@example
1985[New process 35 thread 27]
1986@end example
1987
1988@noindent
1989when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1990the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1991further qualifier.
1992
1993@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1994@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1995@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1996@c program?
1997@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1998@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1999@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2000
2001@cindex thread number
2002@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2003For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2004number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2005
2006@table @code
2007@kindex info threads
2008@item info threads
2009Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2010program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2011
2012@enumerate
2013@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2014
2015@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2016
2017@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2018@end enumerate
2019
2020@noindent
2021An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2022indicates the current thread.
2023
5d161b24 2024For example,
c906108c
SS
2025@end table
2026@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2027
2028@smallexample
2029(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2030 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2031 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2032* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2033 at threadtest.c:68
2034@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2035
2036On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2037
2038@cindex thread number
2039@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2040For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2041number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2042thread in your program.
2043
41afff9a
EZ
2044@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2045@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2046@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2047@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2048@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2049Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2050both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2051form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2052whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2053HP-UX, you see
2054
2055@example
2056[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2057@end example
2058
2059@noindent
5d161b24 2060when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2061
2062@table @code
2063@kindex info threads
2064@item info threads
2065Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2066program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2067
2068@enumerate
2069@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2070
2071@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2072
2073@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2074@end enumerate
2075
2076@noindent
2077An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2078indicates the current thread.
2079
5d161b24 2080For example,
c906108c
SS
2081@end table
2082@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2083
2084@example
2085(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2086 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2087 at quicksort.c:137
2088 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2089 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2090 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2091 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2092@end example
c906108c
SS
2093
2094@table @code
2095@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2096@item thread @var{threadno}
2097Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2098argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2099shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2100@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2101you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2102
2103@smallexample
2104@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2105(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2106[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21070x34e5 in sigpause ()
2108@end smallexample
2109
2110@noindent
2111As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2112@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2113threads.
c906108c
SS
2114
2115@kindex thread apply
2116@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2117The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2118more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2119with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2120@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2121threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2122@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2123@end table
2124
2125@cindex automatic thread selection
2126@cindex switching threads automatically
2127@cindex threads, automatic switching
2128Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2129signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2130signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2131message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2132thread.
2133
2134@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2135more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2136programs with multiple threads.
2137
2138@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2139watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2140
6d2ebf8b 2141@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2142@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2143
2144@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2145@cindex multiple processes
2146@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2147On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2148programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2149function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2150parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2151set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2152will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2153will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2154
2155However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2156which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2157the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2158only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2159so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2160on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2161get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2162@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2163the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2164the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2165
53a5351d
JM
2166On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2167debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2168@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2169
2170By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2171the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2172
2173If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2174use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2175
2176@table @code
2177@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2178@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2179Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2180@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2181process. The @var{mode} can be:
2182
2183@table @code
2184@item parent
2185The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2186unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2187
2188@item child
2189The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2190unimpeded.
2191
2192@item ask
2193The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2194@end table
2195
2196@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2197Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2198@end table
2199
2200If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2201@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2202breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2203@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2204the child process's @code{main}.
2205
2206When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2207child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2208
2209If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2210call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2211use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2212argument.
2213
2214You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2215a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2216Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2217
6d2ebf8b 2218@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2219@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2220
2221The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2222program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2223trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2224
7a292a7a
SS
2225Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2226such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2227@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2228change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2229continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2230ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2231explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2232
2233@table @code
2234@kindex info program
2235@item info program
2236Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2237running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2238@end table
2239
2240@menu
2241* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2242* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2243* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2244* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2245@end menu
2246
6d2ebf8b 2247@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2248@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2249
2250@cindex breakpoints
2251A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2252the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2253control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2254breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2255Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2256should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2257program.
2258
2259In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2260breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2261a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2262is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2263not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2264arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2265
2266@cindex watchpoints
2267@cindex memory tracing
2268@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2269@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2270A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2271when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2272command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2273watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2274any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2275and watchpoints using the same commands.
2276
2277You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2278whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2279Automatic display}.
2280
2281@cindex catchpoints
2282@cindex breakpoint on events
2283A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2284when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2285exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2286different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2287catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2288other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2289@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2290
2291@cindex breakpoint numbers
2292@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2293@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2294catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2295starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2296features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2297breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2298@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2299enable it again.
2300
c5394b80
JM
2301@cindex breakpoint ranges
2302@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2303Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2304operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2305@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2306hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2307all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2308
c906108c
SS
2309@menu
2310* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2311* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2312* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2313* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2314* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2315* Conditions:: Break conditions
2316* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2317* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2318* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2319@end menu
2320
6d2ebf8b 2321@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2322@subsection Setting breakpoints
2323
5d161b24 2324@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2325@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2326@c
2327@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2328
2329@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2330@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2331@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2332@cindex latest breakpoint
2333Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2334@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2335number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2336Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2337convenience variables.
2338
2339You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2340
2341@table @code
2342@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2343Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2344When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2345C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2346@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2347
2348@item break +@var{offset}
2349@itemx break -@var{offset}
2350Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2351at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2352(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2353
2354@item break @var{linenum}
2355Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2356The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2357The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2358code on that line.
2359
2360@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2361Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2362
2363@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2364Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2365@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2366superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2367functions.
2368
2369@item break *@var{address}
2370Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2371breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2372information or source files.
2373
2374@item break
2375When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2376the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2377(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2378innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2379returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2380@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2381that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2382@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2383the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2384inside loops.
2385
2386@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2387least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2388would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2389breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2390existed when your program stopped.
2391
2392@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2393Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2394@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2395value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2396@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2397above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2398,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2399
2400@kindex tbreak
2401@item tbreak @var{args}
2402Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2403same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2404way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2405program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2406
c906108c
SS
2407@kindex hbreak
2408@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2409Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2410@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2411breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2412have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2413debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2414changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2415provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2416will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2417address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2418breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2419example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2420@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2421or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2422(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2423
2424@kindex thbreak
2425@item thbreak @var{args}
2426Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2427are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2428the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2429the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2430first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2431command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2432may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2433See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2434
2435@kindex rbreak
2436@cindex regular expression
2437@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2438Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2439@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2440matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2441breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2442the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2443them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2444
2445The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2446like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2447shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2448an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2449@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2450match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2451
b37052ae 2452When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2453breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2454classes.
c906108c
SS
2455
2456@kindex info breakpoints
2457@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2458@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2459@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2460@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2461Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2462not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2463
2464@table @emph
2465@item Breakpoint Numbers
2466@item Type
2467Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2468@item Disposition
2469Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2470@item Enabled or Disabled
2471Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2472that are not enabled.
2473@item Address
2df3850c 2474Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2475@item What
2476Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2477line number.
2478@end table
2479
2480@noindent
2481If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2482the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2483are listed after that.
2484
2485@noindent
2486@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2487number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2488convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2489the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2490listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2491
2492@noindent
2493@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2494has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2495@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2496hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2497was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2498will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2499@end table
2500
2501@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2502your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2503the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2504(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2505
2506@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2507@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2508@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2509purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2510These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2511@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2512
2513You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2514@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2515
2516@table @code
2517@kindex maint info breakpoints
2518@item maint info breakpoints
2519Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2520breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2521internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2522breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2523is shown:
2524
2525@table @code
2526@item breakpoint
2527Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2528
2529@item watchpoint
2530Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2531
2532@item longjmp
2533Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2534@code{longjmp} calls.
2535
2536@item longjmp resume
2537Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2538
2539@item until
2540Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2541
2542@item finish
2543Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2544
c906108c
SS
2545@item shlib events
2546Shared library events.
53a5351d 2547
c906108c 2548@end table
53a5351d 2549
c906108c
SS
2550@end table
2551
2552
6d2ebf8b 2553@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2554@subsection Setting watchpoints
2555
2556@cindex setting watchpoints
2557@cindex software watchpoints
2558@cindex hardware watchpoints
2559You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2560expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2561this may happen.
2562
2563Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2564hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2565program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2566times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2567catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2568culprit.)
2569
d4f3574e 2570On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2571@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2572hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2573program.
2574
2575@table @code
2576@kindex watch
2577@item watch @var{expr}
2578Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2579is written into by the program and its value changes.
2580
2581@kindex rwatch
2582@item rwatch @var{expr}
2583Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2584
2585@kindex awatch
2586@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2587Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2588by the program.
c906108c
SS
2589
2590@kindex info watchpoints
2591@item info watchpoints
2592This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2593it is the same as @code{info break}.
2594@end table
2595
2596@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2597watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2598value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2599cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2600executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2601statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2602
2603When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2604
2605@example
2606Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2607@end example
2608
2609@noindent
2610if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2611
7be570e7
JM
2612Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2613hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2614value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2615every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2616that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2617hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2618will print a message like this:
2619
2620@smallexample
2621Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2622@end smallexample
2623
2624Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2625data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2626watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2627can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2628cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2629double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2630wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2631into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2632
2633If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2634to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2635Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2636time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2637able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2638warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2639
2640@smallexample
2641Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2642@end smallexample
2643
2644@noindent
2645If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2646
2647The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2648or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2649data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2650hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2651both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2652watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2653@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2654watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2655@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2656Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2657
2658If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2659any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2660kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2661
7be570e7
JM
2662@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2663(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2664they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2665which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2666being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2667and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2668rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2669way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2670@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2671
c906108c
SS
2672@quotation
2673@cindex watchpoints and threads
2674@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2675@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2676usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2677can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2678you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2679thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2680can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2681@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2682the expression.
53a5351d 2683
d4f3574e 2684@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2685@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2686have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2687watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2688single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2689change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2690confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2691software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2692when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2693watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2694@end quotation
c906108c 2695
6d2ebf8b 2696@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2697@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2698@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2699@cindex exception handlers
2700@cindex event handling
2701
2702You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2703kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2704shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2705
2706@table @code
2707@kindex catch
2708@item catch @var{event}
2709Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2710@table @code
2711@item throw
2712@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2713The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2714
2715@item catch
2716@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2717The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2718
2719@item exec
2720@kindex catch exec
2721A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723@item fork
2724@kindex catch fork
2725A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2726
2727@item vfork
2728@kindex catch vfork
2729A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2730
2731@item load
2732@itemx load @var{libname}
2733@kindex catch load
2734The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2735@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2736
2737@item unload
2738@itemx unload @var{libname}
2739@kindex catch unload
2740The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2741of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2742@end table
2743
2744@item tcatch @var{event}
2745Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2746automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2747
2748@end table
2749
2750Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2751
b37052ae 2752There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2753(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2754
2755@itemize @bullet
2756@item
2757If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2758control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2759raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2760returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2761simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2762that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2763you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2764disabled within interactive calls.
2765
2766@item
2767You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2768
2769@item
2770You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2771@end itemize
2772
2773@cindex raise exceptions
2774Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2775if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2776stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2777can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2778breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2779out where the exception was raised.
2780
2781To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2782knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2783raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2784which has the following ANSI C interface:
2785
2786@example
2787 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2788 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2789 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2790@end example
2791
2792@noindent
2793To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2794unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2795(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2796
2797With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2798that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2799a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2800breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2801raised.
2802
2803
6d2ebf8b 2804@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2805@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2806
2807@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2808@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2809It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2810catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2811to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2812breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2813
2814With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2815where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2816delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2817their breakpoint numbers.
2818
2819It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2820automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2821when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2822
2823@table @code
2824@kindex clear
2825@item clear
2826Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2827selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2828the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2829breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2830
2831@item clear @var{function}
2832@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2833Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2834
2835@item clear @var{linenum}
2836@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2837Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2838
2839@cindex delete breakpoints
2840@kindex delete
41afff9a 2841@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2842@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2843Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2844ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2845breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2846confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2847@end table
2848
6d2ebf8b 2849@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2850@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2851
2852@kindex disable breakpoints
2853@kindex enable breakpoints
2854Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2855prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2856it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2857that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2858
2859You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2860the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2861or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2862@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2863catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2864
2865A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2866states of enablement:
2867
2868@itemize @bullet
2869@item
2870Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2871with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2872@item
2873Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2874@item
2875Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2876disabled.
c906108c
SS
2877@item
2878Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2879immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2880set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2881@end itemize
2882
2883You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2884watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2885
2886@table @code
2887@kindex disable breakpoints
2888@kindex disable
41afff9a 2889@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2890@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2891Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2892listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2893options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2894case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2895@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2896
2897@kindex enable breakpoints
2898@kindex enable
c5394b80 2899@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2900Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2901become effective once again in stopping your program.
2902
c5394b80 2903@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2904Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2905of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2906
c5394b80 2907@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2908Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2909deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2910@end table
2911
d4f3574e
SS
2912@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2913@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2914Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2915,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2916subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2917the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2918breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2919breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2920stepping}.)
2921
6d2ebf8b 2922@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2923@subsection Break conditions
2924@cindex conditional breakpoints
2925@cindex breakpoint conditions
2926
2927@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2928@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2929The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2930specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2931breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2932programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2933a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2934and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2935
2936This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2937situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2938when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2939by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2940@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2941
2942Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2943since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2944it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2945and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2946one.
2947
2948Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2949your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2950that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2951format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2952unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2953that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2954program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2955breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2956conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2957purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2958(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2959
2960Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2961@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2962Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2963with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2964
c906108c
SS
2965You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2966The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2967@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2968catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2969
2970@table @code
2971@kindex condition
2972@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2973Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2974watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2975breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2976@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2977@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2978syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2979referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2980symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2981prints an error message:
2982
2983@example
2984No symbol "foo" in current context.
2985@end example
2986
2987@noindent
c906108c
SS
2988@value{GDBN} does
2989not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2990command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2991@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2992
2993@item condition @var{bnum}
2994Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2995an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2996@end table
2997
2998@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2999A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3000breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3001useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3002count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3003is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3004therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3005ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3006the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3007value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3008your program reaches it.
3009
3010@table @code
3011@kindex ignore
3012@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3013Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3014The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3015execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3016takes no action.
3017
3018To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3019a count of zero.
3020
3021When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3022breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3023@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3024Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3025
3026If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3027condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3028@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3029
3030You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3031as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3032is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3033variables}.
3034@end table
3035
3036Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3037
3038
6d2ebf8b 3039@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3040@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3041
3042@cindex breakpoint commands
3043You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3044commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3045example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3046enable other breakpoints.
3047
3048@table @code
3049@kindex commands
3050@kindex end
3051@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3052@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3053@itemx end
3054Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3055themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3056@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3057
3058To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3059follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3060
3061With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3062breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3063recently encountered).
3064@end table
3065
3066Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3067disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3068
3069You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3070use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3071that resumes execution.
3072
3073Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3074execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3075(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3076another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3077ambiguities about which list to execute.
3078
3079@kindex silent
3080If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3081usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3082be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3083then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3084see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3085meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3086
3087The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3088print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3089breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3090
3091For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3092value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3093
3094@example
3095break foo if x>0
3096commands
3097silent
3098printf "x is %d\n",x
3099cont
3100end
3101@end example
3102
3103One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3104you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3105of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3106erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3107to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3108so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3109command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3110
3111@example
3112break 403
3113commands
3114silent
3115set x = y + 4
3116cont
3117end
3118@end example
3119
6d2ebf8b 3120@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3121@subsection Breakpoint menus
3122@cindex overloading
3123@cindex symbol overloading
3124
b37052ae 3125Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3126to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3127This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3128@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3129a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3130something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3131particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3132you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3133waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3134options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3135sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3136@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3137breakpoints.
3138
3139For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3140breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3141We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3142
3143@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3144@smallexample
3145@group
3146(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3147[0] cancel
3148[1] all
3149[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3150[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3151[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3152[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3153[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3154[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3155> 2 4 6
3156Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3157Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3158Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3159Multiple breakpoints were set.
3160Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3161 breakpoints.
3162(@value{GDBP})
3163@end group
3164@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3165
3166@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3167@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3168@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3169@c
3170@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3171@c
d4f3574e
SS
3172Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3173any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3174attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3175@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3176
3177@example
3178Cannot insert breakpoints.
3179The same program may be running in another process.
3180@end example
3181
3182When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3183
3184@enumerate
3185@item
3186Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3187
3188@item
5d161b24 3189Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3190name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3191that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3192Then start your program again.
3193
3194@item
3195Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3196linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3197to nonsharable executables.
3198@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3199@c @end ifclear
3200
d4f3574e
SS
3201A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3202hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3203
3204@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3205@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3206@smallexample
3207Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3208You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3209@end smallexample
3210
3211@noindent
3212This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3213only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3214watchpoints it needs to insert.
3215
3216When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3217hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3218
3219
6d2ebf8b 3220@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3221@section Continuing and stepping
3222
3223@cindex stepping
3224@cindex continuing
3225@cindex resuming execution
3226@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3227completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3228one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3229line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3230particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3231your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3232it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3233@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3234
3235@table @code
3236@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3237@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3238@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3239@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3240@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3241@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3242Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3243any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3244@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3245ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3246@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3247
3248The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3249stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3250@code{continue} is ignored.
3251
d4f3574e
SS
3252The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3253debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3254purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3255@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3256@end table
3257
3258To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3259(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3260calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3261different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3262
3263A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3264(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3265beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3266is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3267and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3268interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3269
3270@table @code
3271@kindex step
41afff9a 3272@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3273@item step
3274Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3275line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3276abbreviated @code{s}.
3277
3278@quotation
3279@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3280@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3281@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3282@c distinction here.
3283@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3284within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3285execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3286debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3287is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3288without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3289below.
3290@end quotation
3291
4a92d011
EZ
3292The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3293line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3294@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3295to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3296the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3297called within the line.
c906108c 3298
d4f3574e
SS
3299Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3300number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3301@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3302on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3303was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3304
3305@item step @var{count}
3306Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3307breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3308@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3309
3310@kindex next
41afff9a 3311@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3312@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3313Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3314This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3315the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3316control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3317that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3318is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3319
3320An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3321
3322
3323@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3324@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3325@c
3326@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3327@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3328@c function are executed without stopping.
3329
d4f3574e
SS
3330The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3331source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3332@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3333
b90a5f51
CF
3334@kindex set step-mode
3335@item set step-mode
3336@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3337@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3338@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3339The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3340stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3341information rather than stepping over it.
3342
4a92d011
EZ
3343This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3344machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3345want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3346
3347@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3348Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3349debug information. This is the default.
3350
c906108c
SS
3351@kindex finish
3352@item finish
3353Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3354returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3355
3356Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3357,Returning from a function}).
3358
3359@kindex until
41afff9a 3360@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3361@item until
3362@itemx u
3363Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3364current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3365stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3366command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3367automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3368than the address of the jump.
3369
3370This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3371though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3372exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3373simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3374through the next iteration.
3375
3376@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3377stack frame.
3378
3379@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3380of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3381example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3382(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3383@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3384
3385@example
3386(@value{GDBP}) f
3387#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3388206 expand_input();
3389(@value{GDBP}) until
3390195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3391@end example
3392
3393This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3394generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3395start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3396written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3397to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3398expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3399statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3400
3401@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3402instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3403argument.
3404
3405@item until @var{location}
3406@itemx u @var{location}
3407Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3408reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3409the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3410,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3411and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3412
3413@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3414@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3415@item stepi
96a2c332 3416@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3417@itemx si
3418Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3419
3420It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3421instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3422instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3423Display,, Automatic display}.
3424
3425An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3426
3427@need 750
3428@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3429@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3430@item nexti
96a2c332 3431@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3432@itemx ni
3433Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3434proceed until the function returns.
3435
3436An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3437@end table
3438
6d2ebf8b 3439@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3440@section Signals
3441@cindex signals
3442
3443A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3444operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3445kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3446signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3447@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3448memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3449the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3450requested an alarm).
3451
3452@cindex fatal signals
3453Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3454functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3455errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3456program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3457@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3458fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3459
3460@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3461program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3462signal.
3463
3464@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3465Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3466@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3467(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3468but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3469You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3470
3471@table @code
3472@kindex info signals
3473@item info signals
96a2c332 3474@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3475Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3476handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3477the defined types of signals.
3478
d4f3574e 3479@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3480
3481@kindex handle
3482@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3483Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3484can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3485@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3486@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3487known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3488@end table
3489
3490@c @group
3491The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3492Their full names are:
3493
3494@table @code
3495@item nostop
3496@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3497still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3498
3499@item stop
3500@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3501the @code{print} keyword as well.
3502
3503@item print
3504@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3505
3506@item noprint
3507@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3508implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3509
3510@item pass
5ece1a18 3511@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3512@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3513can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3514and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3515
3516@item nopass
5ece1a18 3517@itemx ignore
c906108c 3518@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3519@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3520@end table
3521@c @end group
3522
d4f3574e
SS
3523When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3524program until you
c906108c
SS
3525continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3526effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3527after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3528command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3529program sees that signal when you continue.
3530
24f93129
EZ
3531The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3532non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3533@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3534erroneous signals.
3535
c906108c
SS
3536You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3537seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3538or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3539due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3540values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3541execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3542a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3543you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3544program a signal}.
c906108c 3545
6d2ebf8b 3546@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3547@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3548
3549When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3550programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3551breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3552
3553@table @code
3554@cindex breakpoints and threads
3555@cindex thread breakpoints
3556@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3557@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3558@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3559@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3560writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3561
3562Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3563to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3564particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3565numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3566column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3567
3568If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3569breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3570program.
3571
3572You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3573well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3574breakpoint condition, like this:
3575
3576@smallexample
2df3850c 3577(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3578@end smallexample
3579
3580@end table
3581
3582@cindex stopped threads
3583@cindex threads, stopped
3584Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3585@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3586allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3587switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3588underfoot.
3589
3590@cindex continuing threads
3591@cindex threads, continuing
3592Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3593executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3594like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3595
3596In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3597Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3598system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3599execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3600single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3601statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3602stops.
3603
3604You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3605continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3606thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3607first thread completes whatever you requested.
3608
3609On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3610thread to run.
3611
3612@table @code
3613@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3614Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3615locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3616current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3617mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3618``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3619stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3620when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3621function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3622like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3623thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3624@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3625
3626@item show scheduler-locking
3627Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3628@end table
3629
c906108c 3630
6d2ebf8b 3631@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3632@chapter Examining the Stack
3633
3634When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3635stopped and how it got there.
3636
3637@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3638Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3639is generated.
3640That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3641the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3642and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3643The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3644The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3645stack}.
3646
3647When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3648stack allow you to see all of this information.
3649
3650@cindex selected frame
3651One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3652@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3653particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3654your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3655special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3656interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3657
3658When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3659currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3660@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3661
3662@menu
3663* Frames:: Stack frames
3664* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3665* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3666* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3667
3668@end menu
3669
6d2ebf8b 3670@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3671@section Stack frames
3672
d4f3574e 3673@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3674@cindex stack frame
3675The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3676frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3677with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3678to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3679which the function is executing.
3680
3681@cindex initial frame
3682@cindex outermost frame
3683@cindex innermost frame
3684When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3685function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3686@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3687made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3688is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3689the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3690actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3691recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3692
3693@cindex frame pointer
3694Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3695stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3696kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3697address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3698in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3699going on in that frame.
3700
3701@cindex frame number
3702@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3703zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3704and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3705they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3706frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3707
6d2ebf8b
SS
3708@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3709@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3710@cindex frameless execution
3711Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3712without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3713@example
3714@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3715@end example
3716generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3717This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3718the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3719with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3720has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3721it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3722correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3723no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3724
3725@table @code
d4f3574e 3726@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3727@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3728@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3729The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3730and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3731address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3732@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3733
3734@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3735@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3736@item select-frame
3737The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3738to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3739@code{frame}.
3740@end table
3741
6d2ebf8b 3742@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3743@section Backtraces
3744
3745@cindex backtraces
3746@cindex tracebacks
3747@cindex stack traces
3748A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3749line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3750frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3751stack.
3752
3753@table @code
3754@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3755@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3756@item backtrace
3757@itemx bt
3758Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3759frames in the stack.
3760
3761You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3762character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3763
3764@item backtrace @var{n}
3765@itemx bt @var{n}
3766Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3767
3768@item backtrace -@var{n}
3769@itemx bt -@var{n}
3770Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3771@end table
3772
3773@kindex where
3774@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3775@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3776The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3777are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3778
3779Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3780The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3781print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3782line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3783counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3784line number.
3785
3786Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3787@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3788
3789@smallexample
3790@group
5d161b24 3791#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3792 at builtin.c:993
3793#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3794#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3795 at macro.c:71
3796(More stack frames follow...)
3797@end group
3798@end smallexample
3799
3800@noindent
3801The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3802value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3803code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3804
6d2ebf8b 3805@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3806@section Selecting a frame
3807
3808Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3809whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3810selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3811of the stack frame just selected.
3812
3813@table @code
d4f3574e 3814@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3815@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3816@item frame @var{n}
3817@itemx f @var{n}
3818Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3819(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3820innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3821@code{main}.
3822
3823@item frame @var{addr}
3824@itemx f @var{addr}
3825Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3826chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3827impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3828addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3829switches between them.
3830
c906108c
SS
3831On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3832select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3833
3834On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3835pointer and a program counter.
3836
3837On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3838pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3839@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3840@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3841@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3842
3843@kindex up
3844@item up @var{n}
3845Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3846advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3847that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3848
3849@kindex down
41afff9a 3850@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3851@item down @var{n}
3852Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3853advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3854that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3855abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3856@end table
3857
3858All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3859frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3860arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3861frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3862
3863@need 1000
3864For example:
3865
3866@smallexample
3867@group
3868(@value{GDBP}) up
3869#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3870 at env.c:10
387110 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3872@end group
3873@end smallexample
3874
3875After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3876prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3877@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3878
3879@table @code
3880@kindex down-silently
3881@kindex up-silently
3882@item up-silently @var{n}
3883@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3884These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3885respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3886causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3887in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3888distracting.
3889@end table
3890
6d2ebf8b 3891@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3892@section Information about a frame
3893
3894There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3895stack frame.
3896
3897@table @code
3898@item frame
3899@itemx f
3900When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3901frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3902selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3903argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3904@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3905
3906@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3907@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3908@item info frame
3909@itemx info f
3910This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3911including:
3912
3913@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3914@item
3915the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3916@item
3917the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3918@item
3919the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3920@item
3921the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3922@item
3923the address of the frame's arguments
3924@item
d4f3574e
SS
3925the address of the frame's local variables
3926@item
c906108c
SS
3927the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3928@item
3929which registers were saved in the frame
3930@end itemize
3931
3932@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3933something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3934the usual conventions.
3935
3936@item info frame @var{addr}
3937@itemx info f @var{addr}
3938Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3939selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3940command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3941architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3942@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3943
3944@kindex info args
3945@item info args
3946Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3947
3948@item info locals
3949@kindex info locals
3950Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3951line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3952accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3953
c906108c 3954@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3955@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3956@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3957@item info catch
3958Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3959current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3960exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3961@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3962@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3963
c906108c
SS
3964@end table
3965
c906108c 3966
6d2ebf8b 3967@node Source
c906108c
SS
3968@chapter Examining Source Files
3969
3970@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3971information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3972used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3973the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3974(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3975execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3976source files by explicit command.
3977
7a292a7a 3978If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3979prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3980@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3981
3982@menu
3983* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3984* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3985* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3986* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3987@end menu
3988
6d2ebf8b 3989@node List
c906108c
SS
3990@section Printing source lines
3991
3992@kindex list
41afff9a 3993@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3994To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3995(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3996There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3997
3998Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3999
4000@table @code
4001@item list @var{linenum}
4002Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4003current source file.
4004
4005@item list @var{function}
4006Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4007@var{function}.
4008
4009@item list
4010Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4011@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4012printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4013as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4014Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4015
4016@item list -
4017Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4018@end table
4019
4020By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4021the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4022
4023@table @code
4024@kindex set listsize
4025@item set listsize @var{count}
4026Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4027the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4028
4029@kindex show listsize
4030@item show listsize
4031Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4032@end table
4033
4034Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4035so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4036than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4037argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4038each repetition moves up in the source file.
4039
4040@cindex linespec
4041In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4042@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4043of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4044Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4045
4046@table @code
4047@item list @var{linespec}
4048Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4049
4050@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4051Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4052linespecs.
4053
4054@item list ,@var{last}
4055Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4056
4057@item list @var{first},
4058Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4059
4060@item list +
4061Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4062
4063@item list -
4064Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4065
4066@item list
4067As described in the preceding table.
4068@end table
4069
4070Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4071kinds of linespec.
4072
4073@table @code
4074@item @var{number}
4075Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4076When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4077the same source file as the first linespec.
4078
4079@item +@var{offset}
4080Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4081When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4082two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4083first linespec.
4084
4085@item -@var{offset}
4086Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4087
4088@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4089Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4090
4091@item @var{function}
4092Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4093For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4094
4095@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4096Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4097function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4098file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4099identically named functions in different source files.
4100
4101@item *@var{address}
4102Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4103@var{address} may be any expression.
4104@end table
4105
6d2ebf8b 4106@node Search
c906108c
SS
4107@section Searching source files
4108@cindex searching
4109@kindex reverse-search
4110
4111There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4112regular expression.
4113
4114@table @code
4115@kindex search
4116@kindex forward-search
4117@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4118@itemx search @var{regexp}
4119The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4120starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4121@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4122synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4123@code{fo}.
4124
4125@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4126The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4127with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4128for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4129this command as @code{rev}.
4130@end table
c906108c 4131
6d2ebf8b 4132@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4133@section Specifying source directories
4134
4135@cindex source path
4136@cindex directories for source files
4137Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4138files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4139the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4140session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4141this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4142it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4143in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4144the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4145the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4146path.
4147
4148If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4149object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4150too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4151compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4152last resort.
4153
4154Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4155any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4156each line is in the file.
4157
4158@kindex directory
4159@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4160When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4161and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4162To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4163
4164@table @code
4165@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4166@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4167Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4168directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4169(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4170part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4171whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4172path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4173
4174@kindex cdir
4175@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4176@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4177@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4178@cindex compilation directory
4179@cindex current directory
4180@cindex working directory
4181@cindex directory, current
4182@cindex directory, compilation
4183You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4184directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4185working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4186tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4187session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4188directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4189
4190@item directory
4191Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4192
4193@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4194@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4195
4196@item show directories
4197@kindex show directories
4198Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4199@end table
4200
4201If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4202interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4203versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4204
4205@enumerate
4206@item
4207Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4208
4209@item
4210Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4211directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4212directories in one command.
4213@end enumerate
4214
6d2ebf8b 4215@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4216@section Source and machine code
4217
4218You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4219addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4220a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4221mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4222line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4223well as hex.
4224
4225@table @code
4226@kindex info line
4227@item info line @var{linespec}
4228Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4229source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4230the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4231source lines}).
4232@end table
4233
4234For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4235the object code for the first line of function
4236@code{m4_changequote}:
4237
d4f3574e
SS
4238@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4239@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4240@smallexample
96a2c332 4241(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4242Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4243@end smallexample
4244
4245@noindent
4246We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4247@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4248@smallexample
4249(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4250Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4251@end smallexample
4252
4253@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4254@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4255After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4256is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4257sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4258,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4259convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4260variables}).
4261
4262@table @code
4263@kindex disassemble
4264@cindex assembly instructions
4265@cindex instructions, assembly
4266@cindex machine instructions
4267@cindex listing machine instructions
4268@item disassemble
4269This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4270instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4271program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4272command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4273surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4274(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4275@end table
4276
c906108c
SS
4277The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4278HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4279
4280@smallexample
4281(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4282Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42830x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42840x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42850x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42860x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42870x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42880x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42890x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42900x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4291End of assembler dump.
4292@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4293
4294Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4295mnemonics or other syntax.
4296
4297@table @code
d4f3574e 4298@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4299@cindex assembly instructions
4300@cindex instructions, assembly
4301@cindex machine instructions
4302@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4303@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4304@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4305@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4306Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4307program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4308
4309Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4310can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4311The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4312assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4313@end table
4314
4315
6d2ebf8b 4316@node Data
c906108c
SS
4317@chapter Examining Data
4318
4319@cindex printing data
4320@cindex examining data
4321@kindex print
4322@kindex inspect
4323@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4324@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4325@c different window or something like that.
4326The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4327command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4328evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4329program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4330Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4331
4332@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4333@item print @var{expr}
4334@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4335@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4336value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4337you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4338@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4339formats}.
4340
4341@item print
4342@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4343If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4344@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4345conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4346@end table
4347
4348A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4349It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4350specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4351
7a292a7a 4352If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4353fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4354command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4355Table}.
c906108c
SS
4356
4357@menu
4358* Expressions:: Expressions
4359* Variables:: Program variables
4360* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4361* Output Formats:: Output formats
4362* Memory:: Examining memory
4363* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4364* Print Settings:: Print settings
4365* Value History:: Value history
4366* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4367* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4368* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4369* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4370@end menu
4371
6d2ebf8b 4372@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4373@section Expressions
4374
4375@cindex expressions
4376@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4377compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4378by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4379@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4380and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4381by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4382
d4f3574e
SS
4383@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4384the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4385you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4386memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4387
c906108c
SS
4388Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4389this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4390Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4391languages.
4392
4393In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4394expressions regardless of your programming language.
4395
4396Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4397useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4398at that address in memory.
4399@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4400
4401@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4402to programming languages:
4403
4404@table @code
4405@item @@
4406@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4407@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4408
4409@item ::
4410@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4411function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4412
4413@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4414@cindex type casting memory
4415@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4416@cindex casts, to view memory
4417@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4418Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4419memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4420pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4421a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4422normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4423@end table
4424
6d2ebf8b 4425@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4426@section Program variables
4427
4428The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4429in your program.
4430
4431Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4432(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4433
4434@itemize @bullet
4435@item
4436global (or file-static)
4437@end itemize
4438
5d161b24 4439@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4440
4441@itemize @bullet
4442@item
4443visible according to the scope rules of the
4444programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4445@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4446
4447@noindent This means that in the function
4448
4449@example
4450foo (a)
4451 int a;
4452@{
4453 bar (a);
4454 @{
4455 int b = test ();
4456 bar (b);
4457 @}
4458@}
4459@end example
4460
4461@noindent
4462you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4463executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4464examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4465the block where @code{b} is declared.
4466
4467@cindex variable name conflict
4468There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4469scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4470in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4471function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4472happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4473you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4474using the colon-colon notation:
4475
d4f3574e 4476@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4477@iftex
4478@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4479@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4480@end iftex
4481@example
4482@var{file}::@var{variable}
4483@var{function}::@var{variable}
4484@end example
4485
4486@noindent
4487Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4488static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4489make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4490to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4491
4492@example
4493(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4494@end example
4495
b37052ae 4496@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4497This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4498use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4499scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4500@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4501@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4502
4503@cindex wrong values
4504@cindex variable values, wrong
4505@quotation
4506@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4507wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4508scope, and just before exit.
4509@end quotation
4510You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4511This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4512set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4513stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4514values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4515also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4516after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4517variable definitions may be gone.
4518
4519This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4520To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4521when compiling.
4522
d4f3574e
SS
4523@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4524Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4525unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4526opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4527offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4528might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4529happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4530
4531@example
4532No symbol "foo" in current context.
4533@end example
4534
4535To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4536different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4537formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4538supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4539in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4540to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4541debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4542Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4543information.
4544
4545
6d2ebf8b 4546@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4547@section Artificial arrays
4548
4549@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4550@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4551It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4552same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4553dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4554program.
4555
4556You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4557@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4558operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4559and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4560of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4561the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4562argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4563following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4564example. If a program says
4565
4566@example
4567int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4568@end example
4569
4570@noindent
4571you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4572
4573@example
4574p *array@@len
4575@end example
4576
4577The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4578with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4579subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4580Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4581(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4582
4583Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4584This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4585The value need not be in memory:
4586@example
4587(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4588$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4589@end example
4590
4591As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4592@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4593the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4594@example
4595(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4596$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4597@end example
4598
4599Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4600moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4601actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4602of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4603to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4604variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4605interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4606instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4607structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4608in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4609
4610@example
4611set $i = 0
4612p dtab[$i++]->fv
4613@key{RET}
4614@key{RET}
4615@dots{}
4616@end example
4617
6d2ebf8b 4618@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4619@section Output formats
4620
4621@cindex formatted output
4622@cindex output formats
4623By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4624this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4625in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4626at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4627these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4628
4629The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4630already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4631@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4632letters supported are:
4633
4634@table @code
4635@item x
4636Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4637hexadecimal.
4638
4639@item d
4640Print as integer in signed decimal.
4641
4642@item u
4643Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4644
4645@item o
4646Print as integer in octal.
4647
4648@item t
4649Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4650@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4651used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4652see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4653
4654@item a
4655@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4656@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4657Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4658the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4659where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4660
4661@example
4662(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4663$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4664@end example
4665
3d67e040
EZ
4666@noindent
4667The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4668@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4669
c906108c
SS
4670@item c
4671Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4672
4673@item f
4674Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4675using typical floating point syntax.
4676@end table
4677
4678For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4679
4680@example
4681p/x $pc
4682@end example
4683
4684@noindent
4685Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4686names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4687
4688To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4689you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4690expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4691
6d2ebf8b 4692@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4693@section Examining memory
4694
4695You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4696any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4697
4698@cindex examining memory
4699@table @code
41afff9a 4700@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4701@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4702@itemx x @var{addr}
4703@itemx x
4704Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4705@end table
4706
4707@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4708much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4709expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4710If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4711Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4712
4713@table @r
4714@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4715The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4716how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4717@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4718@c 4.1.2.
4719
4720@item @var{f}, the display format
4721The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4722@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4723The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4724The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4725
4726@item @var{u}, the unit size
4727The unit size is any of
4728
4729@table @code
4730@item b
4731Bytes.
4732@item h
4733Halfwords (two bytes).
4734@item w
4735Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4736@item g
4737Giant words (eight bytes).
4738@end table
4739
4740Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4741default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4742@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4743
4744@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4745@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4746memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4747it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4748@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4749@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4750other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4751the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4752starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4753a value from memory).
4754@end table
4755
4756For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4757(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4758starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4759words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4760@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4761
4762Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4763letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4764unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4765specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4766(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4767
4768Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4769and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4770@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4771including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4772alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4773Code,,Source and machine code}.
4774
4775All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4776easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4777you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4778instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4779with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4780the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4781for successive uses of @code{x}.
4782
4783@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4784The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4785in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4786would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4787subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4788@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4789examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4790@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4791the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4792
4793If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4794are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4795address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4796
6d2ebf8b 4797@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4798@section Automatic display
4799@cindex automatic display
4800@cindex display of expressions
4801
4802If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4803(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4804display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4805Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4806to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4807The automatic display looks like this:
4808
4809@example
48102: foo = 38
48113: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4812@end example
4813
4814@noindent
4815This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4816displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4817specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4818whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4819format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4820or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4821supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4822
4823@table @code
4824@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4825@item display @var{expr}
4826Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4827each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4828
4829@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4830
d4f3574e 4831@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4832For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4833count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4834arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4835@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4836
4837@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4838For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4839number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4840be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4841doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4842@end table
4843
4844For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4845instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4846is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4847
4848@table @code
4849@kindex delete display
4850@kindex undisplay
4851@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4852@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4853Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4854
4855@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4856(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4857
4858@kindex disable display
4859@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4860Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4861item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4862enabled again later.
4863
4864@kindex enable display
4865@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4866Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4867again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4868
4869@item display
4870Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4871done when your program stops.
4872
4873@kindex info display
4874@item info display
4875Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4876automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4877values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4878It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4879because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4880@end table
4881
4882If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4883sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4884expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4885variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4886@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4887@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4888continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4889there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4890automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4891is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4892
6d2ebf8b 4893@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4894@section Print settings
4895
4896@cindex format options
4897@cindex print settings
4898@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4899and symbols are printed.
4900
4901@noindent
4902These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4903
4904@table @code
4905@kindex set print address
4906@item set print address
4907@itemx set print address on
4908@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4909traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4910even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4911is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4912@code{set print address on}:
4913
4914@smallexample
4915@group
4916(@value{GDBP}) f
4917#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4918 at input.c:530
4919530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4920@end group
4921@end smallexample
4922
4923@item set print address off
4924Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4925this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4926
4927@smallexample
4928@group
4929(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4930(@value{GDBP}) f
4931#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4932530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4933@end group
4934@end smallexample
4935
4936You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4937dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4938@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4939all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4940
4941@kindex show print address
4942@item show print address
4943Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4944@end table
4945
4946When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4947closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4948identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4949source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4950@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4951you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4952it prints a symbolic address:
4953
4954@table @code
4955@kindex set print symbol-filename
4956@item set print symbol-filename on
4957Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4958symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4959
4960@item set print symbol-filename off
4961Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4962default.
4963
4964@kindex show print symbol-filename
4965@item show print symbol-filename
4966Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4967line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4968@end table
4969
4970Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4971numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4972number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4973
4974Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4975printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4976
4977@table @code
4978@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4979@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4980Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4981offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4982@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4983to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4984
4985@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4986@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4987Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4988symbolic address.
4989@end table
4990
4991@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4992@cindex pointer, finding referent
4993If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4994@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4995and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4996@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4997For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4998at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4999
5000@example
5001(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5002(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5003$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5004@end example
5005
5006@quotation
5007@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5008does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5009the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5010@end quotation
5011
5012Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5013
5014@table @code
5015@kindex set print array
5016@item set print array
5017@itemx set print array on
5018Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5019but uses more space. The default is off.
5020
5021@item set print array off
5022Return to compressed format for arrays.
5023
5024@kindex show print array
5025@item show print array
5026Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5027arrays.
5028
5029@kindex set print elements
5030@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5031Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5032If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5033printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5034This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5035When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5036Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5037
5038@kindex show print elements
5039@item show print elements
5040Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5041If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5042
5043@kindex set print null-stop
5044@item set print null-stop
5045Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5046@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5047contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5048The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5049
5050@kindex set print pretty
5051@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5052Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5053per line, like this:
5054
5055@smallexample
5056@group
5057$1 = @{
5058 next = 0x0,
5059 flags = @{
5060 sweet = 1,
5061 sour = 1
5062 @},
5063 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5064@}
5065@end group
5066@end smallexample
5067
5068@item set print pretty off
5069Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5070
5071@smallexample
5072@group
5073$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5074meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5075@end group
5076@end smallexample
5077
5078@noindent
5079This is the default format.
5080
5081@kindex show print pretty
5082@item show print pretty
5083Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5084
5085@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5086@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5087Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5088@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5089character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5090best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5091high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5092
5093@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5094Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5095international character sets, and is the default.
5096
5097@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5098@item show print sevenbit-strings
5099Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5100
5101@kindex set print union
5102@item set print union on
5d161b24 5103Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5104is the default setting.
5105
5106@item set print union off
5107Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5108
5109@kindex show print union
5110@item show print union
5111Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5112structures.
5113
5114For example, given the declarations
5115
5116@smallexample
5117typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5118typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5119typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5120 Bug_forms;
5121
5122struct thing @{
5123 Species it;
5124 union @{
5125 Tree_forms tree;
5126 Bug_forms bug;
5127 @} form;
5128@};
5129
5130struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5131@end smallexample
5132
5133@noindent
5134with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5135
5136@smallexample
5137$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5138@end smallexample
5139
5140@noindent
5141and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5142
5143@smallexample
5144$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5145@end smallexample
5146@end table
5147
c906108c
SS
5148@need 1000
5149@noindent
b37052ae 5150These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5151
5152@table @code
5153@cindex demangling
5154@kindex set print demangle
5155@item set print demangle
5156@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5157Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5158(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5159linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5160
5161@kindex show print demangle
5162@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5163Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5164
5165@kindex set print asm-demangle
5166@item set print asm-demangle
5167@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5168Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5169in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5170The default is off.
5171
5172@kindex show print asm-demangle
5173@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5174Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5175or demangled form.
5176
5177@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5178@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5179@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5180@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5181Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5182represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5183
5184@table @code
5185@item auto
5186Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5187
5188@item gnu
b37052ae 5189Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5190This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5191
5192@item hp
b37052ae 5193Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5194
5195@item lucid
b37052ae 5196Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5197
5198@item arm
b37052ae 5199Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5200@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5201debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5202require further enhancement to permit that.
5203
5204@end table
5205If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5206
5207@kindex show demangle-style
5208@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5209Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5210
5211@kindex set print object
5212@item set print object
5213@itemx set print object on
5214When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5215(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5216the virtual function table.
5217
5218@item set print object off
5219Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5220virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5221
5222@kindex show print object
5223@item show print object
5224Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5225
5226@kindex set print static-members
5227@item set print static-members
5228@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5229Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5230
5231@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5232Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5233
5234@kindex show print static-members
5235@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5236Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5237
5238@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5239@kindex set print vtbl
5240@item set print vtbl
5241@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5242Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5243(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5244ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5245
5246@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5247Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5248
5249@kindex show print vtbl
5250@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5251Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5252@end table
c906108c 5253
6d2ebf8b 5254@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5255@section Value history
5256
5257@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5258Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5259@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5260Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5261(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5262When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5263since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5264symbol table.
5265
5266@cindex @code{$}
5267@cindex @code{$$}
5268@cindex history number
5269The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5270refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5271@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5272printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5273history number.
5274
5275To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5276history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5277remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5278the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5279@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5280is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5281@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5282
5283For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5284want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5285
5286@example
5287p *$
5288@end example
5289
5290If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5291to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5292
5293@example
5294p *$.next
5295@end example
5296
5297@noindent
5298You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5299command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5300
5301Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5302@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5303
5304@example
5305print x
5306set x=5
5307@end example
5308
5309@noindent
5310then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5311remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5312
5313@table @code
5314@kindex show values
5315@item show values
5316Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5317This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5318values} does not change the history.
5319
5320@item show values @var{n}
5321Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5322
5323@item show values +
5324Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5325values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5326@end table
5327
5328Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5329same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5330
6d2ebf8b 5331@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5332@section Convenience variables
5333
5334@cindex convenience variables
5335@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5336@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5337exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5338setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5339of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5340
5341Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5342@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5343the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5344(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5345by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5346
5347You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5348expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5349For example:
5350
5351@example
5352set $foo = *object_ptr
5353@end example
5354
5355@noindent
5356would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5357@code{object_ptr}.
5358
5359Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5360value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5361value with another assignment at any time.
5362
5363Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5364variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5365that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5366variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5367
5368@table @code
5369@kindex show convenience
5370@item show convenience
5371Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5372Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5373@end table
5374
5375One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5376incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5377a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5378
5379@example
5380set $i = 0
5381print bar[$i++]->contents
5382@end example
5383
d4f3574e
SS
5384@noindent
5385Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5386
5387Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5388values likely to be useful.
5389
5390@table @code
41afff9a 5391@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5392@item $_
5393The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5394the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5395commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5396set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5397and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5398except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5399to the type of @code{$__}.
5400
41afff9a 5401@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5402@item $__
5403The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5404to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5405to match the format in which the data was printed.
5406
5407@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5408@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5409The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5410the program being debugged terminates.
5411@end table
5412
53a5351d
JM
5413On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5414begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5415name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5416
6d2ebf8b 5417@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5418@section Registers
5419
5420@cindex registers
5421You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5422with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5423for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5424your machine.
5425
5426@table @code
5427@kindex info registers
5428@item info registers
5429Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5430registers (in the selected stack frame).
5431
5432@kindex info all-registers
5433@cindex floating point registers
5434@item info all-registers
5435Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5436registers.
5437
5438@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5439Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5440As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5441the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5442the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5443@end table
5444
5445@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5446expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5447architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5448@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5449the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5450pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5451register that contains the processor status. For example,
5452you could print the program counter in hex with
5453
5454@example
5455p/x $pc
5456@end example
5457
5458@noindent
5459or print the instruction to be executed next with
5460
5461@example
5462x/i $pc
5463@end example
5464
5465@noindent
5466or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5467one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5468memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5469stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5470stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5471regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5472see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5473
5474@example
5475set $sp += 4
5476@end example
5477
5478Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5479your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5480so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5481shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5482registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5483can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5484is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5485
5486@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5487integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5488special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5489registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5490to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5491(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5492@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5493
5494Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5495means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5496the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5497sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5498coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5499programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5500cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5501that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5502prints the data in both formats.
5503
5504Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5505(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5506value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5507were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5508true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5509frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5510
5511However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5512code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5513@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5514frame makes no difference.
5515
6d2ebf8b 5516@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5517@section Floating point hardware
5518@cindex floating point
5519
5520Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5521you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5522
5523@table @code
5524@kindex info float
5525@item info float
5526Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5527point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5528floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5529the ARM and x86 machines.
5530@end table
c906108c 5531
29e57380
C
5532@node Memory Region Attributes
5533@section Memory Region Attributes
5534@cindex memory region attributes
5535
5536@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5537required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5538to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5539use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5540
5541Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5542memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5543accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5544been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5545all memory.
5546
5547When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5548to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5549
5550@table @code
5551@kindex mem
5552@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5553Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5554with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5555
5556@kindex delete mem
5557@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5558Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5559
5560@kindex disable mem
5561@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5562Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5563A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5564It may be enabled again later.
5565
5566@kindex enable mem
5567@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5568Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5569
5570@kindex info mem
5571@item info mem
5572Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5573for each region.
5574
5575@table @emph
5576@item Memory Region Number
5577@item Enabled or Disabled.
5578Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5579Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5580
5581@item Lo Address
5582The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5583
5584@item Hi Address
5585The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5586
5587@item Attributes
5588The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5589@end table
5590@end table
5591
5592
5593@subsection Attributes
5594
5595@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5596The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5597write accesses to a memory region.
5598
5599While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5600memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5601etc. from accessing memory.
5602
5603@table @code
5604@item ro
5605Memory is read only.
5606@item wo
5607Memory is write only.
5608@item rw
5609Memory is read/write (default).
5610@end table
5611
5612@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5613The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5614accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5615require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5616specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5617
5618@table @code
5619@item 8
5620Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5621@item 16
5622Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5623@item 32
5624Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5625@item 64
5626Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5627@end table
5628
5629@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5630@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5631@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5632@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5633@c
5634@c @table @code
5635@c @item hwbreak
5636@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5637@c @item swbreak (default)
5638@c @end table
5639
5640@subsubsection Data Cache
5641The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5642memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5643protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5644does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5645registers.
5646
5647@table @code
5648@item cache
5649Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5650@item nocache (default)
5651Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5652@end table
5653
5654@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5655@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5656@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5657@c
5658@c @table @code
5659@c @item verify
5660@c @item noverify (default)
5661@c @end table
5662
b37052ae
EZ
5663@node Tracepoints
5664@chapter Tracepoints
5665@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5666@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5667
5668@cindex tracepoints
5669In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5670the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5671anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5672depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5673might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5674fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5675to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5676
5677Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5678specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5679arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5680Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5681those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5682expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5683for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5684a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5685in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5686values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5687unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5688
5689The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5690targets. @xref{Targets}.
5691
5692This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5693
5694@menu
5695* Set Tracepoints::
5696* Analyze Collected Data::
5697* Tracepoint Variables::
5698@end menu
5699
5700@node Set Tracepoints
5701@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5702
5703Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5704tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5705tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5706breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5707one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5708tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5709work on.
5710
5711For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5712of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5713it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5714local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5715commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5716tracepoint was hit.
5717
5718This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5719conditions and actions.
5720
5721@menu
5722* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5723* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5724* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5725* Tracepoint Actions::
5726* Listing Tracepoints::
5727* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5728@end menu
5729
5730@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5731@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5732
5733@table @code
5734@cindex set tracepoint
5735@kindex trace
5736@item trace
5737The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5738Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5739the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5740defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5741debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5742program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5743doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5744cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5745running.
5746
5747Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5748
5749@smallexample
5750(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5751
5752(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5753
5754(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5755
5756(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5757
5758(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5759@end smallexample
5760
5761@noindent
5762You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5763
5764@vindex $tpnum
5765@cindex last tracepoint number
5766@cindex recent tracepoint number
5767@cindex tracepoint number
5768The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5769of the most recently set tracepoint.
5770
5771@kindex delete tracepoint
5772@cindex tracepoint deletion
5773@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5774Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5775default is to delete all tracepoints.
5776
5777Examples:
5778
5779@smallexample
5780(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5781
5782(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5783@end smallexample
5784
5785@noindent
5786You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5787@end table
5788
5789@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5790@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5791
5792@table @code
5793@kindex disable tracepoint
5794@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5795Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5796@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5797the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5798a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5799
5800@kindex enable tracepoint
5801@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5802Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5803tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5804run.
5805@end table
5806
5807@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5808@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5809
5810@table @code
5811@kindex passcount
5812@cindex tracepoint pass count
5813@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5814Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5815automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5816@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5817the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5818@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5819passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5820given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5821user.
5822
5823Examples:
5824
5825@smallexample
5826(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5827
5828(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5829 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5830(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5831(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5832(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5833(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5834(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5835(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5836 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5837 // been executed 2 times
5838 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5839@end smallexample
5840@end table
5841
5842@node Tracepoint Actions
5843@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5844
5845@table @code
5846@kindex actions
5847@cindex tracepoint actions
5848@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5849This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5850tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5851specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5852recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5853@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5854actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5855terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5856far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5857@code{while-stepping}.
5858
5859@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5860To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5861and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5862
5863@smallexample
5864(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5865
5866(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5867
5868(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5869@end smallexample
5870
5871In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5872commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5873hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5874following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5875followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5876@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5877@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5878@code{end} command.
5879
5880@smallexample
5881(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5882(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5883Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5884> collect bar,baz
5885> collect $regs
5886> while-stepping 12
5887 > collect $fp, $sp
5888 > end
5889end
5890@end smallexample
5891
5892@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5893@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5894Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5895This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5896In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5897special arguments are supported:
5898
5899@table @code
5900@item $regs
5901collect all registers
5902
5903@item $args
5904collect all function arguments
5905
5906@item $locals
5907collect all local variables.
5908@end table
5909
5910You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5911with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5912arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5913
f5c37c66
EZ
5914The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5915particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5916
b37052ae
EZ
5917@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5918@item while-stepping @var{n}
5919Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5920new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5921followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5922its own @code{end} command):
5923
5924@smallexample
5925> while-stepping 12
5926 > collect $regs, myglobal
5927 > end
5928>
5929@end smallexample
5930
5931@noindent
5932You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5933@code{stepping}.
5934@end table
5935
5936@node Listing Tracepoints
5937@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5938
5939@table @code
5940@kindex info tracepoints
5941@cindex information about tracepoints
5942@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5943Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5944tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5945defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5946shown:
5947
5948@itemize @bullet
5949@item
5950its number
5951@item
5952whether it is enabled or disabled
5953@item
5954its address
5955@item
5956its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5957@item
5958its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5959@item
5960where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5961@item
5962its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5963@end itemize
5964
5965@smallexample
5966(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5967Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
59681 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
59692 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
59703 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5971(@value{GDBP})
5972@end smallexample
5973
5974@noindent
5975This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5976@end table
5977
5978@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5979@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5980
5981@table @code
5982@kindex tstart
5983@cindex start a new trace experiment
5984@cindex collected data discarded
5985@item tstart
5986This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
5987begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
5988the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5989experiment.
5990
5991@kindex tstop
5992@cindex stop a running trace experiment
5993@item tstop
5994This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
5995stops collecting data.
5996
5997@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5998automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5999(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6000
6001@kindex tstatus
6002@cindex status of trace data collection
6003@cindex trace experiment, status of
6004@item tstatus
6005This command displays the status of the current trace data
6006collection.
6007@end table
6008
6009Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6010
6011@smallexample
6012(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6013(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6014Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6015> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6016> while-stepping 11
6017 > collect $regs
6018 > end
6019> end
6020(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6021 [time passes @dots{}]
6022(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6023@end smallexample
6024
6025
6026@node Analyze Collected Data
6027@section Using the collected data
6028
6029After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6030for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6031collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6032snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6033consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6034examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6035specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6036snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6037registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6038rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6039debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6040(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6041behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6042when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6043the buffer will fail.
6044
6045@menu
6046* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6047* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6048* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6049@end menu
6050
6051@node tfind
6052@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6053
6054@kindex tfind
6055@cindex select trace snapshot
6056@cindex find trace snapshot
6057The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6058@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6059counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6060snapshot is selected.
6061
6062Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6063
6064@table @code
6065@item tfind start
6066Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6067@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6068
6069@item tfind none
6070Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6071
6072@item tfind end
6073Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6074
6075@item tfind
6076No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6077
6078@item tfind -
6079Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6080retracing earlier steps.
6081
6082@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6083Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6084proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6085argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6086for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6087
6088@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6089Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6090program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6091snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6092snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6093
6094@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6095Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6096addresses.
6097
6098@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6099Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6100@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6101
6102@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6103Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6104the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6105that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6106trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6107next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6108@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6109stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6110@end table
6111
6112The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6113designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6114instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6115snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6116trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6117simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6118snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6119@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6120The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6121for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6122no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6123(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6124no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6125tracepoint as the current one.
6126
6127In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6128these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6129scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6130you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6131registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6132
6133@smallexample
6134(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6135(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6136> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6137 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6138> tfind
6139> end
6140
6141Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6142Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6143Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6144Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6145Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6146Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6147Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6148Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6149Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6150Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6151Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6152@end smallexample
6153
6154Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6155the buffer:
6156
6157@smallexample
6158(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6159(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6160> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6161> tfind line
6162> end
6163
6164Frame 0, X = 1
6165Frame 7, X = 2
6166Frame 13, X = 255
6167@end smallexample
6168
6169@node tdump
6170@subsection @code{tdump}
6171@kindex tdump
6172@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6173@cindex tracepoint data, display
6174
6175This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6176the current trace snapshot.
6177
6178@smallexample
6179(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6180(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6181Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6182> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6183> end
6184
6185(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6186
6187(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6188#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6189at gdb_test.c:444
6190444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6191
6192(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6193Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6194d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6195d1 0x18 24
6196d2 0x80 128
6197d3 0x33 51
6198d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6199d5 0x22 34
6200d6 0xe0 224
6201d7 0x380035 3670069
6202a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6203a1 0x3000668 50333288
6204a2 0x100 256
6205a3 0x322000 3284992
6206a4 0x3000698 50333336
6207a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6208fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6209sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6210ps 0x0 0
6211pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6212fpcontrol 0x0 0
6213fpstatus 0x0 0
6214fpiaddr 0x0 0
6215p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6216p1 = (void *) 0x11
6217p2 = (void *) 0x22
6218p3 = (void *) 0x33
6219p4 = (void *) 0x44
6220p5 = (void *) 0x55
6221p6 = (void *) 0x66
6222gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6223
6224(@value{GDBP})
6225@end smallexample
6226
6227@node save-tracepoints
6228@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6229@kindex save-tracepoints
6230@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6231
6232This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6233their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6234suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6235tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6236Files}).
6237
6238@node Tracepoint Variables
6239@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6240@cindex tracepoint variables
6241@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6242
6243@table @code
6244@vindex $trace_frame
6245@item (int) $trace_frame
6246The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6247snapshot is selected.
6248
6249@vindex $tracepoint
6250@item (int) $tracepoint
6251The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6252
6253@vindex $trace_line
6254@item (int) $trace_line
6255The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6256
6257@vindex $trace_file
6258@item (char []) $trace_file
6259The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6260
6261@vindex $trace_func
6262@item (char []) $trace_func
6263The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6264@end table
6265
6266Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6267use @code{output} instead.
6268
6269Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6270stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6271data.
6272
6273@smallexample
6274(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6275
6276(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6277> output $trace_file
6278> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6279> tfind
6280> end
6281@end smallexample
6282
6d2ebf8b 6283@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6284@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6285@cindex languages
6286
c906108c
SS
6287Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6288rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6289dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6290Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6291represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6292@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6293
6294@cindex working language
6295Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6296allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6297native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6298consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6299language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6300language}.
6301
6302@menu
6303* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6304* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6305* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6306* Support:: Supported languages
6307@end menu
6308
6d2ebf8b 6309@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6310@section Switching between source languages
6311
6312There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6313set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6314@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6315defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6316used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6317are printed, etc.
6318
6319In addition to the working language, every source file that
6320@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6321file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6322source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6323language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6324controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6325show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6326set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6327set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6328Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6329
6330This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6331as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6332another language. In that case, make the
6333program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6334@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6335program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6336
6337@menu
6338* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6339* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6340* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6341@end menu
6342
6d2ebf8b 6343@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6344@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6345
6346If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6347@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6348
6349@table @file
6350
6351@item .c
6352C source file
6353
6354@item .C
6355@itemx .cc
6356@itemx .cp
6357@itemx .cpp
6358@itemx .cxx
6359@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6360C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6361
6362@item .f
6363@itemx .F
6364Fortran source file
6365
c906108c
SS
6366@item .ch
6367@itemx .c186
6368@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6369CHILL source file
c906108c 6370
c906108c
SS
6371@item .mod
6372Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6373
6374@item .s
6375@itemx .S
6376Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6377@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6378@end table
6379
6380In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6381extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6382
6d2ebf8b 6383@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6384@subsection Setting the working language
6385
6386If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6387expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6388your program.
6389
6390@kindex set language
6391If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6392command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6393a language, such as
c906108c 6394@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6395For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6396
c906108c
SS
6397Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6398language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6399to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6400source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6401languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6402source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6403command such as:
6404
6405@example
6406print a = b + c
6407@end example
6408
6409@noindent
6410might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6411@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6412printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6413@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6414
6d2ebf8b 6415@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6416@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6417
6418To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6419@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6420then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6421frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6422working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6423frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6424or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6425does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6426not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6427
6428This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6429entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6430written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6431a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6432case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6433
6d2ebf8b 6434@node Show
c906108c 6435@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6436
6437The following commands help you find out which language is the
6438working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6439
6440@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6441@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6442@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6443@table @code
6444@item show language
6445Display the current working language. This is the
6446language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6447build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6448
6449@item info frame
5d161b24 6450Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6451working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6452@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6453information listed here.
6454
6455@item info source
6456Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6457@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6458information listed here.
6459@end table
6460
6461In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6462not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6463with a language explicitly:
6464
6465@kindex set extension-language
6466@kindex info extensions
6467@table @code
6468@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6469Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6470the source language @var{language}.
6471
6472@item info extensions
6473List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6474@end table
6475
6d2ebf8b 6476@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6477@section Type and range checking
6478
6479@quotation
6480@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6481checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6482section documents the intended facilities.
6483@end quotation
6484@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6485
6486Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6487errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6488checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6489sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6490these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6491by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6492errors when your program is running.
6493
6494@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6495Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6496can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6497the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6498@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6499your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6500for the default settings of supported languages.
6501
6502@menu
6503* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6504* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6505@end menu
6506
6507@cindex type checking
6508@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6509@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6510@subsection An overview of type checking
6511
6512Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6513arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6514otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6515errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6516
6517@smallexample
65181 + 2 @result{} 3
6519@exdent but
6520@error{} 1 + 2.3
6521@end smallexample
6522
6523The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6524type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6525
5d161b24
DB
6526For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6527@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6528to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6529or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6530but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6531these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6532also issues a warning.
6533
5d161b24
DB
6534Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6535related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6536For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6537a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6538with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6539the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6540
6541Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6542instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6543operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6544represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6545operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6546details on specific languages.
6547
6548@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6549
d4f3574e 6550@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6551@kindex set check type
6552@kindex show check type
6553@table @code
6554@item set check type auto
6555Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6556@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6557each language.
6558
6559@item set check type on
6560@itemx set check type off
6561Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6562current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6563match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6564evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6565message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6566
6567@item set check type warn
6568Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6569evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6570be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6571numbers and structures.
6572
6573@item show type
5d161b24 6574Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6575is setting it automatically.
6576@end table
6577
6578@cindex range checking
6579@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6580@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
6581@subsection An overview of range checking
6582
6583In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6584bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6585checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6586computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6587not exceed the bounds of the array.
6588
6589For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6590@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6591always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6592warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6593
6594A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6595array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6596of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6597error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6598result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6599the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6600
6601@example
6602@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6603@end example
6604
6605This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6606specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6607Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6608
6609@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6610
d4f3574e 6611@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
6612@kindex set check range
6613@kindex show check range
6614@table @code
6615@item set check range auto
6616Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6617@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6618each language.
6619
6620@item set check range on
6621@itemx set check range off
6622Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6623current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
6624match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6625then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
6626
6627@item set check range warn
6628Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6629but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6630expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6631memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6632systems).
6633
6634@item show range
6635Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6636being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6637@end table
c906108c 6638
6d2ebf8b 6639@node Support
c906108c 6640@section Supported languages
c906108c 6641
b37052ae 6642@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 6643@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6644Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6645language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6646and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6647,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6648language.
6649
6650The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6651supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6652tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6653@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6654formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6655books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6656language reference or tutorial.
6657
c906108c 6658@menu
b37052ae 6659* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 6660* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6661* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6662@end menu
6663
6d2ebf8b 6664@node C
b37052ae 6665@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 6666
b37052ae
EZ
6667@cindex C and C@t{++}
6668@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 6669
b37052ae 6670Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
6671to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6672together.
6673
41afff9a
EZ
6674@cindex C@t{++}
6675@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
6676@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6677The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6678compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6679effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6680C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6681compiler (@code{aCC}).
6682
b37052ae 6683For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
6684format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6685command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6686@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6687CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6688
c906108c 6689@menu
b37052ae
EZ
6690* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6691* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6692* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6693* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6694* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 6695* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 6696* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 6697@end menu
c906108c 6698
6d2ebf8b 6699@node C Operators
b37052ae 6700@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 6701
b37052ae 6702@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
6703
6704Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6705@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6706often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6707
b37052ae 6708For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6709
6710@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6711
c906108c 6712@item
c906108c 6713@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 6714specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6715
6716@item
d4f3574e
SS
6717@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6718@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6719
6720@item
53a5351d 6721@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6722
6723@item
6724@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6725
c906108c
SS
6726@end itemize
6727
6728@noindent
6729The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6730in order of increasing precedence:
6731
6732@table @code
6733@item ,
6734The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6735are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6736expression being the last expression evaluated.
6737
6738@item =
6739Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6740assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6741
6742@item @var{op}=
6743Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6744and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6745@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6746@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6747@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6748
6749@item ?:
6750The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6751of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6752integral type.
6753
6754@item ||
6755Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6756
6757@item &&
6758Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6759
6760@item |
6761Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6762
6763@item ^
6764Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6765
6766@item &
6767Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6768
6769@item ==@r{, }!=
6770Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6771expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6772
6773@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6774Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6775Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6776and non-zero for true.
6777
6778@item <<@r{, }>>
6779left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6780
6781@item @@
6782The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6783
6784@item +@r{, }-
6785Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6786pointer types.
6787
6788@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6789Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6790defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6791integral types.
6792
6793@item ++@r{, }--
6794Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6795operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6796when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6797operation takes place.
6798
6799@item *
6800Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6801@code{++}.
6802
6803@item &
6804Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6805
b37052ae
EZ
6806For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6807allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 6808(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 6809where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 6810stored.
c906108c
SS
6811
6812@item -
6813Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6814precedence as @code{++}.
6815
6816@item !
6817Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6818@code{++}.
6819
6820@item ~
6821Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6822@code{++}.
6823
6824
6825@item .@r{, }->
6826Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6827@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6828pointer based on the stored type information.
6829Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6830
c906108c
SS
6831@item .*@r{, }->*
6832Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6833
6834@item []
6835Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6836@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6837
6838@item ()
6839Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6840
c906108c 6841@item ::
b37052ae 6842C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 6843and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6844
6845@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6846Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6847(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6848above.
c906108c
SS
6849@end table
6850
c906108c
SS
6851If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6852attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6853predefined meaning.
c906108c 6854
c906108c 6855@menu
5d161b24 6856* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6857@end menu
6858
6d2ebf8b 6859@node C Constants
b37052ae 6860@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6861
b37052ae 6862@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6863
b37052ae 6864@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 6865following ways:
c906108c
SS
6866
6867@itemize @bullet
6868@item
6869Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6870specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6871a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6872@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6873@code{long} value.
6874
6875@item
6876Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6877point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6878exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6879@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6880sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6881A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6882@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6883the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6884a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6885constant.
c906108c
SS
6886
6887@item
6888Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6889integral equivalents.
6890
6891@item
6892Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6893(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6894(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6895be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6896the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6897of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6898@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6899@samp{\n} for newline.
6900
6901@item
96a2c332
SS
6902String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6903double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6904above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6905a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6906characters.
c906108c
SS
6907
6908@item
6909Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6910to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6911
6912@item
6913Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6914and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6915integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6916and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6917@end itemize
6918
c906108c 6919@menu
5d161b24
DB
6920* C plus plus expressions::
6921* C Defaults::
6922* C Checks::
c906108c 6923
5d161b24 6924* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6925@end menu
6926
6d2ebf8b 6927@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
6928@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6929
6930@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6931@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6932
6933@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6934@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6935@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6936@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6937@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6938@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6939@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6940@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6941@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6942@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6943@c periodically whether this has happened...
6944@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
6945@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6946proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
6947additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6948special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6949@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6950symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6951you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6952extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 6953@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6954support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6955@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6956
6957@enumerate
6958
6959@cindex member functions
6960@item
6961Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6962
6963@example
6964count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6965@end example
6966
41afff9a 6967@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 6968@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6969@item
6970While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6971expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6972that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 6973pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 6974
c906108c 6975@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6976@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 6977@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6978@item
6979You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6980call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6981perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6982calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6983in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6984default arguments.
6985
6986It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6987promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6988class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6989functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6990number of function arguments.
6991
6992Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6993@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 6994,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 6995
d4f3574e 6996You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6997explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6998@smallexample
6999p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7000@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7001
c906108c 7002The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 7003see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 7004
c906108c
SS
7005@cindex reference declarations
7006@item
b37052ae
EZ
7007@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7008them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7009dereferenced.
7010
7011In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7012reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7013avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7014The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7015you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7016
7017@item
b37052ae 7018@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7019expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7020one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7021necessary, for example in an expression like
7022@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7023resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7024debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7025@end enumerate
7026
b37052ae 7027In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7028calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7029objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7030invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7031
6d2ebf8b 7032@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7033@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7034
b37052ae 7035@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7036
c906108c
SS
7037If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7038both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7039C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7040selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7041
7042If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7043recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7044@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7045these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7046@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7047for further details.
7048
c906108c
SS
7049@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7050@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7051@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7052
6d2ebf8b 7053@node C Checks
b37052ae 7054@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7055
b37052ae 7056@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7057
b37052ae 7058By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7059is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7060considers two variables type equivalent if:
7061
7062@itemize @bullet
7063@item
7064The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7065enumerated tag.
7066
7067@item
7068The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7069declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7070
7071@ignore
7072@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7073@c FIXME--beers?
7074@item
7075The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7076declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7077compilers.)
7078@end ignore
7079@end itemize
7080
7081Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7082indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7083that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7084
6d2ebf8b 7085@node Debugging C
c906108c 7086@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7087
7088The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7089the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7090inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7091appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7092
7093The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7094with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7095,Expressions}.
7096
c906108c 7097@menu
5d161b24 7098* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7099@end menu
7100
6d2ebf8b 7101@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7102@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7103
b37052ae 7104@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7105
b37052ae
EZ
7106Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7107designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7108
7109@table @code
7110@cindex break in overloaded functions
7111@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7112When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7113@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7114you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7115
b37052ae 7116@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7117@item rbreak @var{regex}
7118Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7119breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7120classes.
7121@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7122
b37052ae 7123@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7124@item catch throw
7125@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7126Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7127Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7128
7129@cindex inheritance
7130@item ptype @var{typename}
7131Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7132@var{typename}.
7133@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7134
b37052ae 7135@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7136@item set print demangle
7137@itemx show print demangle
7138@itemx set print asm-demangle
7139@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7140Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7141displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7142@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7143
7144@item set print object
7145@itemx show print object
7146Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7147@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7148
7149@item set print vtbl
7150@itemx show print vtbl
7151Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7152@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7153(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7154ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7155
7156@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7157@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7158@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7159Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7160is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7161and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7162using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7163expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7164message.
7165
7166@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7167Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7168overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7169chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7170symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7171overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7172searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7173argument types.
c906108c
SS
7174
7175@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7176You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7177the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7178@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7179also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7180available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7181@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7182@end table
c906108c 7183
6d2ebf8b 7184@node Modula-2
c906108c 7185@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7186
d4f3574e 7187@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7188
7189The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7190output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7191developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7192attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7193to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7194table.
7195
7196@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7197@menu
7198* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7199* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7200* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7201* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7202* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7203* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7204* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7205* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7206@end menu
7207
6d2ebf8b 7208@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7209@subsubsection Operators
7210@cindex Modula-2 operators
7211
7212Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7213@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7214often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7215following definitions hold:
7216
7217@itemize @bullet
7218
7219@item
7220@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7221their subranges.
7222
7223@item
7224@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7225
7226@item
7227@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7228
7229@item
7230@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7231@var{type}}.
7232
7233@item
7234@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7235
7236@item
7237@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7238
7239@item
7240@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7241@end itemize
7242
7243@noindent
7244The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7245increasing precedence:
7246
7247@table @code
7248@item ,
7249Function argument or array index separator.
7250
7251@item :=
7252Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7253@var{value}.
7254
7255@item <@r{, }>
7256Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7257types.
7258
7259@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7260Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7261on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7262set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7263
7264@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7265Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7266Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7267available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7268comment character.
7269
7270@item IN
7271Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7272Same precedence as @code{<}.
7273
7274@item OR
7275Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7276
7277@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7278Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7279
7280@item @@
7281The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7282
7283@item +@r{, }-
7284Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7285and difference on set types.
7286
7287@item *
7288Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7289on set types.
7290
7291@item /
7292Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7293types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7294
7295@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7296Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7297precedence as @code{*}.
7298
7299@item -
7300Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7301
7302@item ^
7303Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7304
7305@item NOT
7306Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7307@code{^}.
7308
7309@item .
7310@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7311precedence as @code{^}.
7312
7313@item []
7314Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7315
7316@item ()
7317Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7318as @code{^}.
7319
7320@item ::@r{, }.
7321@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7322@end table
7323
7324@quotation
7325@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7326treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7327@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7328@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7329@end quotation
7330
cb51c4e0 7331
6d2ebf8b 7332@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 7333@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 7334@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
7335
7336Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7337In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7338
7339@table @var
7340
7341@item a
7342represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7343
7344@item c
7345represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7346
7347@item i
7348represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7349
7350@item m
7351represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7352same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7353be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7354
7355@item n
7356represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7357
7358@item r
7359represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7360
7361@item t
7362represents a type.
7363
7364@item v
7365represents a variable.
7366
7367@item x
7368represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7369explanation of the function for details.
7370@end table
7371
7372All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7373
7374@table @code
7375@item ABS(@var{n})
7376Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7377
7378@item CAP(@var{c})
7379If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7380equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7381
7382@item CHR(@var{i})
7383Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7384
7385@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7386Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7387
7388@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7389Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7390new value.
7391
7392@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7393Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7394set.
7395
7396@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7397Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7398
7399@item HIGH(@var{a})
7400Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7401
7402@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7403Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7404
7405@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7406Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7407new value.
7408
7409@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7410Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7411there. Returns the new set.
7412
7413@item MAX(@var{t})
7414Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7415
7416@item MIN(@var{t})
7417Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7418
7419@item ODD(@var{i})
7420Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7421
7422@item ORD(@var{x})
7423Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7424value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7425@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7426integral, character and enumerated types.
7427
7428@item SIZE(@var{x})
7429Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7430
7431@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7432Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7433
7434@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7435Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7436@end table
7437
7438@quotation
7439@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7440@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7441an error.
7442@end quotation
7443
7444@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7445@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7446@subsubsection Constants
7447
7448@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7449ways:
7450
7451@itemize @bullet
7452
7453@item
7454Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7455expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7456rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7457trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7458
7459@item
7460Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7461decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7462then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7463@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7464digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7465digits.
7466
7467@item
7468Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7469like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7470also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7471followed by a @samp{C}.
7472
7473@item
7474String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7475pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7476Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7477Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7478sequences.
7479
7480@item
7481Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7482
7483@item
7484Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7485@code{FALSE}.
7486
7487@item
7488Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7489
7490@item
7491Set constants are not yet supported.
7492@end itemize
7493
6d2ebf8b 7494@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7495@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7496@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7497
7498If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7499both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7500Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7501selected the working language.
7502
7503If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7504code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7505working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7506the language automatically}, for further details.
7507
6d2ebf8b 7508@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7509@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7510@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7511
7512A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7513This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7514
7515@itemize @bullet
7516@item
7517Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7518integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7519debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7520pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7521through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7522returned a pointer.)
7523
7524@item
7525C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7526non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7527escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7528printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7529
7530@item
7531The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7532argument.
7533
7534@item
7535All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7536@end itemize
7537
6d2ebf8b 7538@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7539@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7540@cindex Modula-2 checks
7541
7542@quotation
7543@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7544range checking.
7545@end quotation
7546@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7547
7548@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7549
7550@itemize @bullet
7551@item
7552They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7553@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7554
7555@item
7556They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7557@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7558@end itemize
7559
7560As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7561whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7562
7563Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7564index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7565
6d2ebf8b 7566@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7567@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7568@cindex scope
41afff9a 7569@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7570@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7571@ifinfo
41afff9a 7572@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7573@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7574@end ifinfo
7575@iftex
41afff9a 7576@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7577@end iftex
7578
7579There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7580(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7581similar syntax:
7582
7583@example
7584
7585@var{module} . @var{id}
7586@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7587@end example
7588
7589@noindent
7590where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7591@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7592identifier within your program, except another module.
7593
7594Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7595specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7596found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7597enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7598
7599Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7600the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7601definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7602an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7603module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7604@var{module}.
7605
6d2ebf8b 7606@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
7607@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7608
7609Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7610Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 7611specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 7612@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 7613apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
7614analogue in Modula-2.
7615
7616The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 7617with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 7618intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 7619created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 7620address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 7621@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
7622
7623@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7624In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7625interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 7626
6d2ebf8b 7627@node Chill
cce74817
JM
7628@subsection Chill
7629
7630The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 7631from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
7632supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7633likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7634table.
7635
d4f3574e
SS
7636@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7637@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7638This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
7639of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7640
7641@menu
104c1213
JM
7642* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7643* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7644* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7645* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7646* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7647@end menu
7648
6d2ebf8b 7649@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7650@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7651
7652The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7653with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7654slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7655provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7656
7657@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7658@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7659@table @code
7660@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7661@itemize @bullet
7662@item
7663@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7664UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7665@item
5d161b24 7666@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7667@item
5d161b24 7668@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7669@item
7670@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7671@smallexample
7672(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7673type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7674@end smallexample
7675If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7676@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7677@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7678@smallexample
7679@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7680@end smallexample
7681where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7682expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7683@end itemize
7684
7685@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7686A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7687the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7688@smallexample
7689(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7690type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7691@end smallexample
7692
7693@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7694@itemize @bullet
7695@item
d4f3574e 7696@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7697followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7698@item
7699@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7700@end itemize
7701
7702@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7703The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7704<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7705list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7706the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7707all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7708
7709@ignore
7710@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7711The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7712type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7713@end ignore
7714
5d161b24 7715@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7716@itemize @bullet
7717@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7718@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7719@smallexample
7720@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7721@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7722where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7723@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7724@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7725@smallexample
7726@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7727@end smallexample
7728where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7729@end itemize
7730
5d161b24 7731@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7732@itemize @bullet
7733@item
7734@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7735@item
7736@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7737@end itemize
7738
7739@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7740Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7741
7742@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7743@itemize @bullet
7744@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7745@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7746@smallexample
7747@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7748@end smallexample
7749followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7750mode
cce74817 7751@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7752@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7753@smallexample
7754@code{BOOLS(<string
7755length>)}
7756@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7757@end itemize
7758
7759@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7760The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7761followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7762@smallexample
7763(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7764type = ARRAY (1:42)
7765 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7766 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7767@end smallexample
7768
5d161b24 7769@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7770The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7771list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7772of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7773OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7774of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7775checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7776always displays all variant fields.
7777@smallexample
7778(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7779type = STRUCT (
7780 as x,
7781 bs x,
7782 CASE bs OF
7783 (karli):
7784 cs a
7785 (ott):
7786 ds x
7787 ESAC
7788)
7789@end smallexample
7790@end table
7791
6d2ebf8b 7792@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7793@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7794
7795A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7796
7797A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7798the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7799Chill programs. How values are specified
7800is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7801
7802The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7803display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7804
cce74817
JM
7805@smallexample
7806set result := EXPR
7807@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7808
7809@noindent
7810This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7811is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7812
7813Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7814value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7815mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7816represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7817value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7818operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7819
6d2ebf8b
SS
7820Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7821@smallexample
7822@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7823(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7824location>}
7825@end smallexample
7826@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7827specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7828the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7829
7830@ignore
7831Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7832fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7833the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7834implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7835na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7836<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7837@code{__proc_copy}.
7838
7839Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7840the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7841like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7842mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7843
7844Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7845...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7846definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7847of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7848structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7849braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7850on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7851memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7852all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7853@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7854stuff ???)
7855@smallexample
7856(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7857[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7858@end smallexample
7859@end ignore
7860
7861Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7862(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7863certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7864and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7865
7866A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7867location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7868name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7869have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7870checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7871therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7872
cce74817
JM
7873@smallexample
7874(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7875@end smallexample
7876
6d2ebf8b 7877@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7878@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7879
7880Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7881more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7882data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7883such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7884constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7885when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7886(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7887the values behind these locations.
7888
d4f3574e 7889This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7890operations are legal to be used with such values.
7891
7892@table @code
7893@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7894Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7895For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7896chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7897@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7898@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7899
5d161b24 7900@ignore
cce74817
JM
7901@itemize @bullet
7902@item
7903@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7904programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7905@item
7906@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7907@item
7908@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7909@code{'M'})
7910@item
7911@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 7912mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 7913comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 7914@item
d4f3574e 7915@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7916emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7917procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7918
7919@item
7920@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7921enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7922to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7923@item
7924@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7925programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7926@item
7927@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7928(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7929@end itemize
7930@end ignore
7931
7932@item Tuple Values
7933A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7934name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7935unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7936@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7937
cce74817
JM
7938@itemize @bullet
7939@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7940@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7941@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7942Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7943same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7944@end itemize
7945
7946@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7947A string element value is specified by
7948@smallexample
7949@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7950@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7951where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7952value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7953the string.
7954
7955@item String Slice Value
7956A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7957spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7958expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7959@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7960The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7961string.
7962
7963@item Array Element Values
7964An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7965delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7966
7967@item Array Slice Values
7968An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7969@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7970@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7971arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7972which is part of the specified array.
7973
7974@item Structure Field Values
7975A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7976name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7977in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7978corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7979
7980@item Procedure Call Value
7981The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7982procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7983expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7984effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7985
d4f3574e 7986Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7987
6d2ebf8b
SS
7988Values of time mode locations appear as
7989@smallexample
7990@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7991@end smallexample
7992
cce74817
JM
7993
7994@ignore
7995This is not implemented yet:
7996@item Built-in Value
7997@noindent
7998The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7999
cce74817
JM
8000@table @code
8001@item @code{ADDR()}
8002@item @code{NUM()}
8003@item @code{PRED()}
8004@item @code{SUCC()}
8005@item @code{ABS()}
8006@item @code{CARD()}
8007@item @code{MAX()}
8008@item @code{MIN()}
8009@item @code{SIZE()}
8010@item @code{UPPER()}
8011@item @code{LOWER()}
8012@item @code{LENGTH()}
8013@item @code{SIN()}
8014@item @code{COS()}
8015@item @code{TAN()}
8016@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8017@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8018@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8019@item @code{EXP()}
8020@item @code{LN()}
8021@item @code{LOG()}
8022@item @code{SQRT()}
8023@end table
8024
8025For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8026chapter 1.6.
8027@end ignore
8028
8029@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8030The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8031current active process.
8032
8033@item Expression Values
8034The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8035the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8036incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8037corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8038causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8039which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8040operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8041
cce74817
JM
8042@table @code
8043@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8044@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8045@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8046Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8047
cce74817
JM
8048@item @code{=, /=}
8049Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8050
cce74817 8051@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8052@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8053Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8054
cce74817 8055@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8056@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8057Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8058
cce74817
JM
8059@item @code{-}
8060Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8061
cce74817
JM
8062@item @code{//}
8063String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8064
cce74817
JM
8065@item @code{()}
8066String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8067
cce74817
JM
8068@item @code{->}
8069Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8070address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8071location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8072
cce74817 8073@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8074@itemx @code{AND}
8075@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8076Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8077
cce74817 8078@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8079@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8080Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8081
cce74817
JM
8082@item @code{IN}
8083Membership operator.
8084@end table
8085@end table
8086
6d2ebf8b 8087@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8088@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8089
8090@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8091of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8092complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8093equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8094structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8095
8096Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8097index bounds and all built in procedures.
8098
8099Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8100check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8101operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8102functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8103language specification.
8104
cce74817
JM
8105All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8106off}.
8107
5d161b24 8108@ignore
53a5351d 8109@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8110see last paragraph ?
8111@end ignore
8112
6d2ebf8b 8113@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8114@subsubsection Chill defaults
8115
8116If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8117both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8118Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8119selected the working language.
8120
8121If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8122code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8123working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8124the language automatically}, for further details.
8125
6d2ebf8b 8126@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8127@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8128
d4f3574e 8129The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8130symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8131program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8132does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8133program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8134(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8135file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8136
8137@cindex symbol names
8138@cindex names of symbols
8139@cindex quoting names
8140Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8141characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8142most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8143source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8144are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8145ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8146@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8147@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8148
8149@example
8150p 'foo.c'::x
8151@end example
8152
8153@noindent
8154looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8155
8156@table @code
8157@kindex info address
b37052ae 8158@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8159@item info address @var{symbol}
8160Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8161variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8162local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8163is always stored.
8164
8165Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8166at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8167the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8168
3d67e040 8169@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8170@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8171@item info symbol @var{addr}
8172Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8173If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8174nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8175
8176@example
8177(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8178_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8179@end example
8180
8181@noindent
8182This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8183it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8184
c906108c 8185@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8186@item whatis @var{expr}
8187Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8188actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8189assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8190@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8191
8192@item whatis
8193Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8194
8195@kindex ptype
8196@item ptype @var{typename}
8197Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8198the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8199@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8200@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8201
d4f3574e 8202@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8203@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8204Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8205differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8206of just the name of the type.
8207
8208For example, for this variable declaration:
8209
8210@example
8211struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8212@end example
8213
8214@noindent
8215the two commands give this output:
8216
8217@example
8218@group
8219(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8220type = struct complex
8221(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8222type = struct complex @{
8223 double real;
8224 double imag;
8225@}
8226@end group
8227@end example
8228
8229@noindent
8230As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8231the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8232
8233@kindex info types
8234@item info types @var{regexp}
8235@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8236Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8237(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8238complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8239@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8240names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8241information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8242
8243This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8244@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8245lists all source files where a type is defined.
8246
b37052ae
EZ
8247@kindex info scope
8248@cindex local variables
8249@item info scope @var{addr}
8250List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8251accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8252preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8253scope defined by that location. For example:
8254
8255@smallexample
8256(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8257Scope for command_line_handler:
8258Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8259Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8260Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8261Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8262Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8263Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8264Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8265@end smallexample
8266
f5c37c66
EZ
8267@noindent
8268This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8269during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8270collect}.
8271
c906108c
SS
8272@kindex info source
8273@item info source
8274Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8275the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8276it was written in.
8277
8278@kindex info sources
8279@item info sources
8280Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8281debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8282have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8283
8284@kindex info functions
8285@item info functions
8286Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8287
8288@item info functions @var{regexp}
8289Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8290whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8291Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8292include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8293start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8294that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8295@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8296
8297@kindex info variables
8298@item info variables
8299Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8300outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8301
8302@item info variables @var{regexp}
8303Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8304variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8305@var{regexp}.
8306
8307@ignore
8308This was never implemented.
8309@kindex info methods
8310@item info methods
8311@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8312The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8313methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8314specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8315C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8316from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8317@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8318which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8319@end ignore
8320
c906108c
SS
8321@cindex reloading symbols
8322Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8323be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8324in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8325running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8326@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8327
8328@table @code
8329@kindex set symbol-reloading
8330@item set symbol-reloading on
8331Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8332object file with a particular name is seen again.
8333
8334@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8335Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8336same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8337running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8338should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8339may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8340several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8341name.
c906108c
SS
8342
8343@kindex show symbol-reloading
8344@item show symbol-reloading
8345Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8346@end table
c906108c 8347
c906108c
SS
8348@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8349@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8350Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8351declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8352@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8353source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8354another source file. The default is on.
8355
8356A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8357the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8358
8359@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8360Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8361is printed as follows:
8362@smallexample
8363@{<no data fields>@}
8364@end smallexample
8365
8366@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8367@item show opaque-type-resolution
8368Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8369
8370@kindex maint print symbols
8371@cindex symbol dump
8372@kindex maint print psymbols
8373@cindex partial symbol dump
8374@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8375@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8376@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8377Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8378These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8379symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8380symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8381collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8382only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8383command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8384use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8385symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8386files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8387@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8388required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8389@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8390@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8391@end table
8392
6d2ebf8b 8393@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8394@chapter Altering Execution
8395
8396Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8397find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8398correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8399experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8400program.
8401
8402For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8403locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8404address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8405
8406@menu
8407* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8408* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8409* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8410* Returning:: Returning from a function
8411* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8412* Patching:: Patching your program
8413@end menu
8414
6d2ebf8b 8415@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8416@section Assignment to variables
8417
8418@cindex assignment
8419@cindex setting variables
8420To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8421@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8422
8423@example
8424print x=4
8425@end example
8426
8427@noindent
8428stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8429value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8430@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8431information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8432
8433@kindex set variable
8434@cindex variables, setting
8435If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8436@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8437really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8438not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8439,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8440
c906108c
SS
8441If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8442appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8443variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8444to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8445program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8446a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8447command @code{set width}:
8448
8449@example
8450(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8451type = double
8452(@value{GDBP}) p width
8453$4 = 13
8454(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8455Invalid syntax in expression.
8456@end example
8457
8458@noindent
8459The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8460order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8461
8462@example
8463(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8464@end example
53a5351d 8465
c906108c
SS
8466Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8467with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8468@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8469your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8470to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8471the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8472
8473@example
8474@group
8475(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8476type = double
8477(@value{GDBP}) p g
8478$1 = 1
8479(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8480(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8481$2 = 1
8482(@value{GDBP}) r
8483The program being debugged has been started already.
8484Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8485Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8486"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8487 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8488(@value{GDBP}) show g
8489The current BFD target is "=4".
8490@end group
8491@end example
8492
8493@noindent
8494The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8495@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8496@code{g}, use
8497
8498@example
8499(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8500@end example
c906108c
SS
8501
8502@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8503freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8504and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8505same length or shorter.
8506@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8507@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8508
8509To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8510construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8511(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8512to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8513and representation in memory), and
8514
8515@example
8516set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8517@end example
8518
8519@noindent
8520stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8521
6d2ebf8b 8522@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8523@section Continuing at a different address
8524
8525Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8526it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8527an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8528
8529@table @code
8530@kindex jump
8531@item jump @var{linespec}
8532Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8533immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8534source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8535@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8536in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8537breakpoints}.
8538
8539The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8540the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8541register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8542a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8543be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8544of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8545confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8546executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8547well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8548
8549@item jump *@var{address}
8550Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8551@end table
8552
c906108c 8553@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8554On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8555command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8556difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8557changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8558example,
c906108c
SS
8559
8560@example
8561set $pc = 0x485
8562@end example
8563
8564@noindent
8565makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8566address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8567@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8568
8569The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8570up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8571that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8572detail.
8573
c906108c 8574@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8575@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8576@section Giving your program a signal
8577
8578@table @code
8579@kindex signal
8580@item signal @var{signal}
8581Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8582signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8583signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8584SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8585
8586Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8587giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8588a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8589@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8590signal.
8591
8592@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8593after executing the command.
8594@end table
8595@c @end group
8596
8597Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8598@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8599causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8600the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8601passes the signal directly to your program.
8602
c906108c 8603
6d2ebf8b 8604@node Returning
c906108c
SS
8605@section Returning from a function
8606
8607@table @code
8608@cindex returning from a function
8609@kindex return
8610@item return
8611@itemx return @var{expression}
8612You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8613command. If you give an
8614@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8615value.
8616@end table
8617
8618When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8619(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8620discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8621be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8622
8623This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8624frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8625innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8626specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8627of functions.
8628
8629The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8630program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8631returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8632and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8633selected stack frame returns naturally.
8634
6d2ebf8b 8635@node Calling
c906108c
SS
8636@section Calling program functions
8637
8638@cindex calling functions
8639@kindex call
8640@table @code
8641@item call @var{expr}
8642Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8643returned values.
8644@end table
8645
8646You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8647execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
8648with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8649is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 8650
c906108c
SS
8651For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8652specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8653calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8654method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8655that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 8656
6d2ebf8b 8657@node Patching
c906108c 8658@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 8659
c906108c
SS
8660@cindex patching binaries
8661@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 8662@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 8663
7a292a7a
SS
8664By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8665executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8666alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8667patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
8668
8669If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8670explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8671want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8672repairs.
8673
8674@table @code
8675@kindex set write
8676@item set write on
8677@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8678If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8679core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8680off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8681
8682If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8683@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8684write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8685
8686@item show write
8687@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8688Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8689as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8690@end table
8691
6d2ebf8b 8692@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8693@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8694
7a292a7a
SS
8695@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8696both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8697program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8698@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8699
8700@menu
8701* Files:: Commands to specify files
8702* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8703@end menu
8704
6d2ebf8b 8705@node Files
c906108c 8706@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8707
7a292a7a 8708@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8709@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8710
8711You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8712way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8713@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8714Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8715
8716Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8717@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8718a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8719to specify new files are useful.
8720
8721@table @code
8722@cindex executable file
8723@kindex file
8724@item file @var{filename}
8725Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8726symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8727executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8728directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8729@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8730directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8731to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8732and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8733
6d2ebf8b 8734On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8735@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8736@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8737@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8738descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8739(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8740@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8741for more information.
c906108c
SS
8742
8743@item file
8744@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8745has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8746
8747@kindex exec-file
8748@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8749Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8750in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8751if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8752discard information on the executable file.
8753
8754@kindex symbol-file
8755@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8756Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8757searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8758table and program to run from the same file.
8759
8760@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8761program's symbol table.
8762
5d161b24 8763The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8764of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8765auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8766the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8767the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8768
8769@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8770executing it once.
8771
8772When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8773understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8774generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8775other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8776Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8777using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8778optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8779
8780For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8781using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8782symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8783quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8784details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8785
8786The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8787start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8788occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8789file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8790pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8791warnings and messages}.)
8792
c906108c
SS
8793We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8794symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8795symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8796still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8797in stabs format.
8798
8799@kindex readnow
8800@cindex reading symbols immediately
8801@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8802@kindex mapped
8803@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8804@cindex saving symbol table
8805@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8806@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8807You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8808tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8809load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8810entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8811
c906108c
SS
8812If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8813@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8814cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8815file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8816from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8817than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8818program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8819starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8820
8821You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8822file has all the symbol information for your program.
8823
8824The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8825@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8826than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8827it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8828needed.
8829
8830The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8831@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8832symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8833
8834@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8835@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8836@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8837@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8838@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8839@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8840@c files.
8841
8842@kindex core
8843@kindex core-file
8844@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8845Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8846of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8847address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8848executable file itself for other parts.
8849
8850@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8851to be used.
8852
8853Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8854under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8855wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8856the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8857(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8858
c906108c
SS
8859@kindex add-symbol-file
8860@cindex dynamic linking
8861@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8862@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 8863@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
8864The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8865information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8866when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8867into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8868address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8869this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8870of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8871section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8872@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8873
8874The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8875originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8876@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8877thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8878instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 8879
17d9d558
JB
8880@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
8881@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
8882@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
8883@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
8884@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
8885Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
8886executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
8887relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
8888information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
8889
8890@itemize @bullet
8891@item
8892the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
8893that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
8894@item
8895every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
8896been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
8897@item
8898you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
8899provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8900@end itemize
8901
8902@noindent
8903Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
8904relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
8905typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
8906important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
8907procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
8908assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
8909general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
8910relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
8911as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
8912way.
8913
c906108c
SS
8914@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8915
8916You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8917the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8918table information for @var{filename}.
8919
8920@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8921@item add-shared-symbol-file
8922The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8923operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8924shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8925@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8926
c906108c
SS
8927@kindex section
8928@item section
5d161b24
DB
8929The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8930the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8931section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8932specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8933separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8934the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8935
8936@kindex info files
8937@kindex info target
8938@item info files
8939@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8940@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8941current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8942including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8943use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8944command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8945current ones.
8946
c906108c
SS
8947@end table
8948
8949All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8950as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8951name and remembers it that way.
8952
c906108c 8953@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8954@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8955libraries.
53a5351d 8956
c906108c
SS
8957@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8958when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8959(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8960references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8961debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8962
8963On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8964automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8965
c906108c
SS
8966@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8967@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8968@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8969
b7209cb4
FF
8970There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
8971symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
8972particularly large or there are many of them.
8973
8974To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
8975commands:
8976
8977@table @code
8978@kindex set auto-solib-add
8979@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
8980If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
8981will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
8982attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
8983informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
8984is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8985@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
8986
8987@kindex show auto-solib-add
8988@item show auto-solib-add
8989Display the current autoloading mode.
8990@end table
8991
8992To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
8993command:
8994
c906108c
SS
8995@table @code
8996@kindex info sharedlibrary
8997@kindex info share
8998@item info share
8999@itemx info sharedlibrary
9000Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9001
9002@kindex sharedlibrary
9003@kindex share
9004@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9005@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9006Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9007Unix regular expression.
9008As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9009required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9010@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9011loaded.
9012@end table
9013
b7209cb4
FF
9014On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9015autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9016reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9017by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9018up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9019wish.
c906108c
SS
9020
9021Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9022loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9023@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9024automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9025
9026To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9027
9028@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9029@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9030@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9031Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9032If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9033symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9034size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9035Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
b7209cb4
FF
9036@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e. 100
9037Mb).
c906108c 9038
b7209cb4
FF
9039@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9040@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9041Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9042@end table
c906108c 9043
6d2ebf8b 9044@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9045@section Errors reading symbol files
9046
9047While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9048such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9049output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9050they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9051debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9052about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9053only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9054times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9055to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9056complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9057messages}).
9058
9059The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9060
9061@table @code
9062@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9063
9064The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9065(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9066error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9067in its outer scope blocks.
9068
9069@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9070the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9071may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9072function.
9073
9074@item block at @var{address} out of order
9075
9076The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9077order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9078do so.
9079
9080@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9081locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9082can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9083@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9084messages}.)
9085
9086@item bad block start address patched
9087
9088The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9089smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9090to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9091
9092@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9093starting on the previous source line.
9094
9095@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9096
9097@cindex foo
9098Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9099larger than the size of the string table.
9100
9101@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9102name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9103with this name.
9104
9105@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9106
7a292a7a
SS
9107The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9108not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9109uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9110
7a292a7a
SS
9111@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9112This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9113are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9114debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9115on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9116and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9117
9118@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9119
7a292a7a 9120@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9121
7a292a7a 9122@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9123The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9124information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9125it.
c906108c
SS
9126
9127@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9128
9129@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9130
c906108c
SS
9131@end table
9132
6d2ebf8b 9133@node Targets
c906108c 9134@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9135
c906108c
SS
9136@cindex debugging target
9137@kindex target
9138
9139A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9140
9141Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9142in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9143you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9144flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9145host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9146realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9147command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9148(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9149
9150@menu
9151* Active Targets:: Active targets
9152* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9153* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9154* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9155* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9156
9157@end menu
9158
6d2ebf8b 9159@node Active Targets
c906108c 9160@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9161
c906108c
SS
9162@cindex stacking targets
9163@cindex active targets
9164@cindex multiple targets
9165
c906108c 9166There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9167executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9168active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9169start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9170a core file.
c906108c
SS
9171
9172For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9173@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9174well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9175@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9176first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9177requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9178are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9179read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9180executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9181
9182When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9183target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9184commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9185an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9186process target is active.
c906108c 9187
7a292a7a
SS
9188Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9189core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9190files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9191the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9192process}).
c906108c 9193
6d2ebf8b 9194@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9195@section Commands for managing targets
9196
9197@table @code
9198@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9199Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9200process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9201facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9202protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9203
9204Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9205typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9206with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9207
9208The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9209after executing the command.
9210
9211@kindex help target
9212@item help target
9213Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9214currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9215(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9216
9217@item help target @var{name}
9218Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9219select it.
9220
9221@kindex set gnutarget
9222@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9223@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9224knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9225a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9226with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9227with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9228
d4f3574e 9229@quotation
c906108c
SS
9230@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9231you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9232@end quotation
c906108c 9233
d4f3574e
SS
9234@noindent
9235@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9236
5d161b24 9237@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9238@item show gnutarget
9239Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9240@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9241@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9242and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9243@end table
9244
c906108c
SS
9245Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9246configuration):
c906108c
SS
9247
9248@table @code
9249@kindex target exec
9250@item target exec @var{program}
9251An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9252@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9253
c906108c
SS
9254@kindex target core
9255@item target core @var{filename}
9256A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9257@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9258
9259@kindex target remote
9260@item target remote @var{dev}
9261Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9262specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9263@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9264supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9265some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9266it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9267
c906108c
SS
9268@kindex target sim
9269@item target sim
2df3850c 9270Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9271In general,
9272@example
9273 target sim
9274 load
9275 run
9276@end example
d4f3574e 9277@noindent
104c1213 9278works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9279drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9280provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9281see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9282Processors}.
9283
c906108c
SS
9284@end table
9285
104c1213 9286Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9287
9288@table @code
9289
c906108c
SS
9290@kindex target nrom
9291@item target nrom @var{dev}
9292NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9293
c906108c
SS
9294@end table
9295
5d161b24 9296Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9297your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9298
9299Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9300once you've successfully established a connection.
9301
9302@table @code
9303
9304@kindex load @var{filename}
9305@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9306Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9307@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9308is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9309on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9310@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9311the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9312
9313If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9314execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9315target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9316
9317The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9318For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9319link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9320specifies a fixed address.
9321@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9322
c906108c
SS
9323@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9324@end table
9325
6d2ebf8b 9326@node Byte Order
c906108c 9327@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9328
c906108c
SS
9329@cindex choosing target byte order
9330@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9331
9332Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9333offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9334orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9335designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9336which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9337@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9338
9339@table @code
9340@kindex set endian big
9341@item set endian big
9342Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9343
9344@kindex set endian little
9345@item set endian little
9346Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9347
9348@kindex set endian auto
9349@item set endian auto
9350Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9351executable.
9352
9353@item show endian
9354Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9355
9356@end table
9357
9358Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9359data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9360target system.
9361
6d2ebf8b 9362@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9363@section Remote debugging
9364@cindex remote debugging
9365
9366If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9367@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9368For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9369or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9370powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9371
9372Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9373to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9374@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9375but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9376write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9377communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9378
9379Other remote targets may be available in your
9380configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9381
c906108c 9382@menu
c906108c 9383* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9384@end menu
9385
6d2ebf8b 9386@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9387@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9388
104c1213
JM
9389@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9390To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9391@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9392prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9393program, you need:
c906108c 9394
104c1213
JM
9395@enumerate
9396@item
9397A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9398have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9399your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9400
5d161b24 9401@item
d4f3574e 9402A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9403subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9404
104c1213
JM
9405@item
9406A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9407download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9408manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9409documentation.
9410@end enumerate
96baa820 9411
104c1213
JM
9412The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9413communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9414machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9415
104c1213
JM
9416@table @emph
9417@item On the host,
9418@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9419else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9420(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9421
9422@item On the target,
9423you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9424implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9425subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9426
9427On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9428@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9429@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9430@end table
96baa820 9431
104c1213
JM
9432The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9433machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9434@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9435
104c1213
JM
9436@cindex remote serial stub list
9437These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9438
104c1213
JM
9439@table @code
9440
9441@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9442@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9443@cindex Intel
9444@cindex i386
9445For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9446
9447@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9448@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9449@cindex Motorola 680x0
9450@cindex m680x0
9451For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9452
9453@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9454@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9455@cindex Hitachi
9456@cindex SH
9457For Hitachi SH architectures.
9458
9459@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 9460@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9461@cindex Sparc
9462For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9463
9464@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 9465@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9466@cindex Fujitsu
9467@cindex SparcLite
9468For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9469
9470@end table
9471
9472The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9473recently added stubs.
9474
9475@menu
9476* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9477* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9478* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9479* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9480* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9481* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9482@end menu
9483
6d2ebf8b 9484@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
9485@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9486
9487@cindex remote serial stub
9488The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9489subroutines:
9490
9491@table @code
9492@item set_debug_traps
9493@kindex set_debug_traps
9494@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9495This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9496program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9497beginning of your program.
9498
9499@item handle_exception
9500@kindex handle_exception
9501@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9502This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9503explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9504run when a trap is triggered.
9505
9506@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9507execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9508with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9509protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 9510representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
9511information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9512retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9513execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9514@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 9515machine.
104c1213
JM
9516
9517@item breakpoint
9518@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9519Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9520breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9521way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9522machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9523pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9524@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9525simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9526again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9527your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 9528@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
9529
9530Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9531to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9532start of your debugging session.
9533@end table
9534
6d2ebf8b 9535@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
9536@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9537
9538@cindex remote stub, support routines
9539The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9540chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9541debugging target machine.
9542
9543First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9544serial port.
9545
9546@table @code
9547@item int getDebugChar()
9548@kindex getDebugChar
9549Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9550It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9551different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9552
9553@item void putDebugChar(int)
9554@kindex putDebugChar
9555Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 9556It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
9557different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9558@end table
9559
9560@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9561@cindex interrupting remote targets
9562If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9563running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9564for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9565character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9566remote system to stop.
9567
9568Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9569probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9570is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9571@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9572
9573Other routines you need to supply are:
9574
9575@table @code
9576@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9577@kindex exceptionHandler
9578Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9579handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9580way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9581are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9582containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9583@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9584its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9585might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9586exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9587@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9588and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9589you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9590should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9591
9592For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9593gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9594should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9595@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9596help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9597
9598@item void flush_i_cache()
9599@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 9600On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
9601instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9602instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9603
9604On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9605function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9606@end table
9607
9608@noindent
9609You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9610
9611@table @code
9612@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9613@kindex memset
9614This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9615memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9616@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9617either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9618@end table
9619
9620If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9621library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9622but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 9623subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
9624
9625
6d2ebf8b 9626@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
9627@subsubsection Putting it all together
9628
9629@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9630In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9631steps.
9632
9633@enumerate
9634@item
6d2ebf8b 9635Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
9636(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9637@display
9638@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9639@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9640@end display
9641
9642@item
9643Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9644
9645@example
9646set_debug_traps();
9647breakpoint();
9648@end example
9649
9650@item
9651For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9652@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9653
9654@example
9655void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9656@end example
9657
d4f3574e 9658@noindent
104c1213 9659but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 9660function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
9661@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9662error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9663one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9664
9665@item
9666Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9667your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9668
9669@item
9670Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9671the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9672
9673@item
9674@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9675@c document that. FIXME.
9676Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9677whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9678
9679@item
9680To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9681as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9682This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9683of its pure text.
9684
d4f3574e 9685@item
104c1213 9686@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9687Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
9688Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9689machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9690TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9691to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9692device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9693
9694@example
9695target remote /dev/ttyb
9696@end example
9697
9698@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9699To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9700@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9701terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9702
9703@example
9704target remote manyfarms:2828
9705@end example
a2bea4c3
CV
9706
9707If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
9708your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
9709the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
9710to port 1234 on your local machine:
9711
9712@example
9713target remote :1234
9714@end example
9715@noindent
9716
9717Note that the colon is still required here.
104c1213
JM
9718@end enumerate
9719
9720Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9721step and continue the remote program.
9722
9723To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9724command.
9725
9726@cindex interrupting remote programs
9727@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9728Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9729interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9730program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9731and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9732interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9733
9734@example
9735Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9736Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9737@end example
9738
9739If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9740(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9741remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9742goes back to waiting.
9743
6d2ebf8b 9744@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9745@subsubsection Communication protocol
9746
9747@cindex debugging stub, example
9748@cindex remote stub, example
9749@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9750The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9751communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9752@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9753these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9754implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9755with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9756organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9757
9758However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9759the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9760target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9761it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9762
9763In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9764transmitted and received data respectfully.
9765
9766@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9767@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9768@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9769All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9770sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9771@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9772@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9773
9774@example
9775@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9776@end example
9777@noindent
104c1213
JM
9778
9779@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9780@noindent
9781The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9782characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9783eight bit unsigned checksum).
9784
9785Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9786specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9787
9788@example
9789@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9790@end example
104c1213
JM
9791
9792@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9793@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9794That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9795has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9796since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9797
6cf7e474 9798@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9799When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9800response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9801the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9802retransmission):
9803
9804@example
9805<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9806-> @code{+}
9807@end example
9808@noindent
104c1213
JM
9809
9810The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9811debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9812the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9813when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9814
9815@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9816exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9817exceptions).
9818
9819Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9820@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9821HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9822
9823Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9824@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9825would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9826
9827Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9828means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9829which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9830@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9831where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9832characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9833value greater than 126 should not be used.
9834
9835Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9836loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9837character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9838
9839So:
9840@example
9841"@code{0* }"
9842@end example
9843@noindent
9844means the same as "0000".
9845
598ca718 9846The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9847error number. That number is not well defined.
9848
9849For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9850(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9851protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9852on that response.
104c1213 9853
f1251bdd
C
9854A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9855@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9856optional.
9857
104c1213
JM
9858Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9859their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9860@page
104c1213
JM
9861@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9862@item Packet
9863@tab Request
9864@tab Description
9865
df2396a1 9866@item extended mode
104c1213
JM
9867@tab @code{!}
9868@tab
df2396a1 9869Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
656db9b0 9870persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
df2396a1 9871debugged.
104c1213 9872@item
df2396a1 9873@tab reply @samp{OK}
104c1213 9874@tab
df2396a1 9875The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
104c1213
JM
9876
9877@item last signal
9878@tab @code{?}
9879@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9880Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9881and continue.
9882@item
9883@tab reply
9884@tab see below
9885
104c1213
JM
9886
9887@item reserved
9888@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9889@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9890
f1251bdd 9891@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9892@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9893@tab
598ca718
EZ
9894@item
9895@tab
9896@tab
104c1213
JM
9897Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9898specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9899See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9900@item
9901@tab reply @code{OK}
9902@item
9903@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9904
9905@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9906@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9907@tab
9908Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9909transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9910transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9911acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9912to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9913ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9914specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9915that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9916happened.}
9917
9918@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9919@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9920@tab
9921Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9922breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9923@samp{z} packets.}
9924
9925@item continue
9926@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9927@tab
9928@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9929current address.
9930@item
9931@tab reply
9932@tab see below
9933
f1251bdd 9934@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9935@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9936@tab
9937Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9938@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9939@item
9940@tab reply
9941@tab see below
9942
598ca718 9943@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9944@tab @code{d}
9945@tab
d4f3574e 9946toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9947
f1251bdd 9948@item detach
104c1213 9949@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9950@tab
2df3850c
JM
9951Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9952@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9953@item
9954@tab reply @emph{no response}
9955@tab
598ca718 9956@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9957
9958@item reserved
9959@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9960@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9961
9962@item reserved
9963@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9964@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9965
9966@item reserved
9967@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9968@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9969
9970@item reserved
9971@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9972@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9973
9974@item read registers
9975@tab @code{g}
9976@tab Read general registers.
9977@item
9978@tab reply @var{XX...}
9979@tab
9980Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9981with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9982each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9983determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9984@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9985@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9986@item
9987@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9988@tab for an error.
9989
9990@item write regs
9991@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9992@tab
9993See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9994@item
9995@tab reply @code{OK}
9996@tab for success
9997@item
9998@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9999@tab for an error
10000
10001@item reserved
10002@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 10003@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10004
f1251bdd 10005@item set thread
104c1213
JM
10006@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
10007@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10008Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
10009@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
10010continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
10011thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
10012@item
10013@tab reply @code{OK}
10014@tab for success
10015@item
10016@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10017@tab for an error
10018
d4f3574e
SS
10019@c FIXME: JTC:
10020@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 10021@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
10022@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
10023@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
10024@c described. For example:
10025@c
10026@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
10027@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
10028@c otherwise returns current registers.
10029@c
10030@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
10031@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
10032@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
10033
f1251bdd 10034@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10035@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
10036@tab
10037Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
10038present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
10039step starting at that address.
10040
f1251bdd 10041@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
10042@tab @code{I}
10043@tab
10044See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
10045
10046@item reserved
10047@tab @code{j}
10048@tab Reserved for future use
10049
10050@item reserved
10051@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 10052@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10053
f1251bdd 10054@item kill request
104c1213
JM
10055@tab @code{k}
10056@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10057FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
10058thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
10059
10060@item reserved
10061@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 10062@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10063
10064@item reserved
10065@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 10066@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10067
10068@item read memory
10069@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10070@tab
10071Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 10072Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
10073using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
10074transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
10075@item
10076@tab reply @var{XX...}
10077@tab
d4f3574e 10078@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 10079to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
10080sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
10081@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
10082@item
10083@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10084@tab @var{NN} is errno
10085
10086@item write mem
10087@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10088@tab
10089Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10090@var{XX...} is the data.
10091@item
10092@tab reply @code{OK}
10093@tab for success
10094@item
10095@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10096@tab
10097for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10098written).
10099
10100@item reserved
10101@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10102@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10103
10104@item reserved
10105@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10106@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10107
10108@item reserved
10109@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10110@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10111
10112@item reserved
10113@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10114@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10115
10116@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10117@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10118@tab
10119See write register.
10120@item
10121@tab return @var{r....}
10122@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10123
f1251bdd 10124@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10125@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10126@tab
10127Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10128digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10129@item
10130@tab reply @code{OK}
10131@tab for success
10132@item
10133@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10134@tab for an error
10135
f1251bdd 10136@item general query
104c1213
JM
10137@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10138@tab
598ca718 10139Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10140have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10141company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10142optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10143must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10144@item
10145@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10146@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10147@item
10148@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10149@tab error reply
10150@item
10151@tab reply @samp{}
10152@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10153
f1251bdd 10154@item general set
104c1213
JM
10155@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10156@tab
10157Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10158naming conventions.
10159
598ca718 10160@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10161@tab @code{r}
10162@tab
10163Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10164
f1251bdd 10165@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10166@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10167@tab
df2396a1
AC
10168Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
10169This packet is only available in extended mode.
10170@item
10171@tab
10172no reply
10173@tab
10174The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
104c1213 10175
f1251bdd 10176@item step
104c1213
JM
10177@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10178@tab
10179@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10180same address.
10181@item
10182@tab reply
10183@tab see below
10184
f1251bdd 10185@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10186@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10187@tab
10188Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10189@item
10190@tab reply
10191@tab see below
10192
f1251bdd 10193@item search
104c1213
JM
10194@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10195@tab
10196Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10197@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10198bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10199
f1251bdd 10200@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10201@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10202@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10203@item
10204@tab reply @code{OK}
10205@tab thread is still alive
10206@item
10207@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10208@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10209
104c1213
JM
10210@item reserved
10211@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10212@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10213
10214@item reserved
10215@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10216@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10217
10218@item reserved
10219@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10220@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10221
10222@item reserved
10223@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10224@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10225
10226@item reserved
10227@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10228@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10229
10230@item reserved
10231@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10232@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10233
10234@item reserved
10235@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10236@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10237
f1251bdd 10238@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10239@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10240@tab
10241@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10242binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10243escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10244@item
10245@tab reply @code{OK}
10246@tab for success
10247@item
10248@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10249@tab for an error
10250
10251@item reserved
10252@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10253@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10254
10255@item reserved
10256@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10257@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10258
f1251bdd 10259@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10260@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10261@tab
10262See @samp{Z}.
10263
f1251bdd 10264@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10265@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10266@tab
10267@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10268breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10269@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10270bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10271the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10272@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10273potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10274implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10275@item
10276@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10277@tab for an error
10278@item
10279@tab reply @code{OK}
10280@tab for success
10281@item
10282@tab @samp{}
10283@tab If not supported.
10284
10285@item reserved
10286@tab <other>
5d161b24 10287@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10288
10289@end multitable
10290
d4f3574e
SS
10291The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10292receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10293@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10294when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10295number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10296conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10297
10298@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10299
10300@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10301@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10302
10303@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10304@tab
10305@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10306(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10307by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10308thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10309starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10310@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10311extend the protocol.
10312
10313@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10314@tab
10315The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10316applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10317
10318@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10319@tab
10320The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10321
6d2ebf8b 10322@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10323@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10324@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10325@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10326@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10327this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10328spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10329debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10330
10331@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10332@tab
c3f6f71d 10333@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10334while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10335for 'W', 'T', etc.
10336
10337@end multitable
10338
d4f3574e
SS
10339The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10340
10341@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10342
10343@item current thread
10344@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10345@tab Return the current thread id.
10346@item
10347@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10348@tab
10349Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10350@item
10351@tab reply *
10352@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10353
bba2971c
MS
10354@item all thread ids
10355@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10356@item
10357@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10358@tab
bba2971c
MS
10359Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10360may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10361works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10362obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10363be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10364sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10365@item
bba2971c
MS
10366@tab
10367@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10368@item
5d161b24 10369@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10370@tab A single thread id
10371@item
00e4a2e4 10372@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10373@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10374@item
10375@tab reply @code{l}
10376@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10377@item
10378@tab
10379@tab
10380In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10381or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10382respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10383@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10384(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10385
10386@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10387@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10388@tab
10389@item
10390@tab
10391@tab
10392Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10393Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10394the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10395thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10396The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10397Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10398"Blocked on Mutex".
10399@item
10400@tab reply @var{XX...}
10401@tab
10402Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10403printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10404attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10405
10406@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10407@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10408@tab
2b628194
MS
10409@item
10410@tab
10411@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10412Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10413digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10414subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10415number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10416(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10417returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10418@item
bba2971c
MS
10419@tab
10420@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10421query (see above).
10422@item
d4f3574e
SS
10423@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10424@tab
2b628194
MS
10425@item
10426@tab
10427@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10428Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10429returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10430and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10431digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10432a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10433digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10434
bba2971c
MS
10435@item compute CRC of memory block
10436@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10437@tab
10438@item
10439@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10440@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10441@item
10442@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10443@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10444
d4f3574e
SS
10445@item query sect offs
10446@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10447@tab
10448Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10449image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10450response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10451offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10452@item
10453@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10454
10455@item thread info request
10456@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10457@tab
598ca718
EZ
10458@item
10459@tab
10460@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10461Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10462encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10463@item
10464@tab reply *
10465@tab
10466See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10467
10468@item remote command
10469@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10470@tab
598ca718
EZ
10471@item
10472@tab
10473@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10474@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10475execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10476Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10477number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10478packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10479stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10480@item
10481@tab reply @code{OK}
10482@tab
10483A command response with no output.
10484@item
10485@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10486@tab
10487A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10488@item
10489@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10490@tab
10491Indicate a badly formed request.
10492
10493@item
10494@tab reply @samp{}
10495@tab
10496When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10497
0f1f2b0a
MS
10498@item symbol lookup
10499@tab @code{qSymbol::}
10500@tab
10501Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
10502requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
10503@item
10504@tab
10505@tab
10506@item
10507@tab reply @code{OK}
10508@tab
10509The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10510@item
10511@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10512@tab
10513The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10514@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
10515@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10516message, described below.
10517
10518@item symbol value
10519@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10520@tab
10521Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
10522@item
10523@tab
10524@tab
10525@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
10526the target has previously requested.
10527@item
10528@tab
10529@tab
10530@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
10531If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
10532field will be empty.
10533@item
10534@tab reply @code{OK}
10535@tab
10536The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10537@item
10538@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10539@tab
10540The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10541@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
10542until the target ceases to request them.
10543
d4f3574e
SS
10544@end multitable
10545
10546The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10547In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10548bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10549space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10550The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10551least-significant.
10552
10553@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10554
10555@item MIPS32
10556@tab
10557All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1055832 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10559registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10560
10561@item MIPS64
10562@tab
10563All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10564thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10565as @code{MIPS32}.
10566
10567@end multitable
10568
104c1213
JM
10569Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10570does not get any direct output:
10571
10572@example
10573<- @code{R00}
10574-> @code{+}
10575@emph{target restarts}
10576<- @code{?}
10577-> @code{+}
10578-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10579<- @code{+}
10580@end example
10581
10582Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10583
10584@example
10585<- @code{G1445...}
10586-> @code{+}
10587<- @code{s}
10588-> @code{+}
10589@emph{time passes}
10590-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10591<- @code{+}
10592<- @code{g}
10593-> @code{+}
10594-> @code{1455...}
10595<- @code{+}
10596@end example
10597
6d2ebf8b 10598@node Server
104c1213
JM
10599@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10600
10601@kindex gdbserver
10602@cindex remote connection without stubs
10603@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10604allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10605@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10606
10607@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10608because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10609that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10610@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10611@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10612because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10613also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10614started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10615Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10616the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10617do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10618by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10619choice for debugging.
10620
10621@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10622or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10623protocol.
10624
10625@table @emph
10626@item On the target machine,
10627you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10628@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10629strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10630system does all the symbol handling.
10631
10632To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10633the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10634syntax is:
10635
10636@smallexample
10637target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10638@end smallexample
10639
10640@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10641hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10642@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10643@file{/dev/com1}:
10644
10645@smallexample
10646target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10647@end smallexample
10648
10649@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10650with it.
10651
10652To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10653
10654@smallexample
10655target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10656@end smallexample
10657
10658The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10659specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10660TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10661expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10662(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10663you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10664TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10665reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10666conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 10667and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
10668@code{target remote} command.
10669
10670@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10671you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10672symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10673using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10674(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10675running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10676remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10677is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10678@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10679@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10680
10681@smallexample
10682(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10683@end smallexample
10684
10685@noindent
10686communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10687
10688@smallexample
10689(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10690@end smallexample
10691
10692@noindent
10693communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10694For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10695the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10696text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10697@samp{Connection refused}.
10698@end table
10699
6d2ebf8b 10700@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
10701@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10702
10703@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10704@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10705allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10706@code{target remote}.
10707
10708@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10709using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10710
10711@table @emph
10712@item On the target machine,
10713you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10714@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10715can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10716host system does all the symbol handling.
10717
10718To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10719@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10720program. The syntax is:
10721
5d161b24 10722@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10723load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10724 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10725@end smallexample
10726
10727@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10728the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 10729to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
10730
10731For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 10732communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 10733using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
10734
10735@smallexample
10736load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10737@end smallexample
10738
10739@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10740you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10741symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10742using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10743(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10744running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10745remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10746argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10747@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10748
10749@smallexample
10750(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10751@end smallexample
10752
10753@noindent
10754communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10755@end table
10756
6d2ebf8b 10757@node KOD
104c1213
JM
10758@section Kernel Object Display
10759
10760@cindex kernel object display
10761@cindex kernel object
10762@cindex KOD
10763
10764Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10765@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10766and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10767mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10768displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10769
10770Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10771@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10772
10773@example
2df3850c 10774(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
10775@end example
10776
10777If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10778about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10779which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10780after the operating system:
10781
10782@example
2df3850c 10783(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
10784List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10785Object Description
10786any Any and all objects
10787@end example
10788
10789Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10790by the kernel.
10791
10792There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10793is supported other than to try it.
10794
10795
6d2ebf8b 10796@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10797@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10798
10799While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10800cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10801describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10802
10803There are three major categories of configurations: native
10804configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10805operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10806different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10807are quite different from each other.
10808
10809@menu
10810* Native::
10811* Embedded OS::
10812* Embedded Processors::
10813* Architectures::
10814@end menu
10815
6d2ebf8b 10816@node Native
104c1213
JM
10817@section Native
10818
10819This section describes details specific to particular native
10820configurations.
10821
10822@menu
10823* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10824* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9f20bf26 10825* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
104c1213
JM
10826@end menu
10827
6d2ebf8b 10828@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10829@subsection HP-UX
10830
10831On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10832begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10833name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10834
6d2ebf8b 10835@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10836@subsection SVR4 process information
10837
10838@kindex /proc
10839@cindex process image
10840
10841Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10842used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10843subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10844this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10845several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10846@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10847@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10848and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10849
10850@table @code
10851@kindex info proc
10852@item info proc
10853Summarize available information about the process.
10854
10855@kindex info proc mappings
10856@item info proc mappings
10857Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10858on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10859
10860@kindex info proc times
10861@item info proc times
10862Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10863its children.
10864
10865@kindex info proc id
10866@item info proc id
10867Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10868the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10869
10870@kindex info proc status
10871@item info proc status
10872General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10873stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10874received.
10875
10876@item info proc all
10877Show all the above information about the process.
10878@end table
10879
9f20bf26
EZ
10880@node DJGPP Native
10881@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10882@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10883@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10884@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
10885
10886@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10887MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10888that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10889top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
10890
10891@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10892defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10893subsection describes those commands.
10894
10895@table @code
10896@kindex info dos
10897@item info dos
10898This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10899information about the target system and important OS structures.
10900
10901@kindex sysinfo
10902@cindex MS-DOS system info
10903@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10904@item info dos sysinfo
10905This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10906platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10907DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
10908
10909@cindex GDT
10910@cindex LDT
10911@cindex IDT
10912@cindex segment descriptor tables
10913@cindex descriptor tables display
10914@item info dos gdt
10915@itemx info dos ldt
10916@itemx info dos idt
10917These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10918and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10919tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10920that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10921descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10922descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10923rights.
10924
10925A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10926segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10927allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10928conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10929additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
10930
10931@cindex garbled pointers
10932These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10933Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10934displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10935display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10936example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10937debugged program's data segment:
10938
10939@smallexample
10940(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds
109410x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)
10942@end smallexample
10943
10944@noindent
10945This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10946the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
10947
10948@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10949@item info dos pde
10950@itemx info dos pte
10951These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10952Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10953data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10954into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10955page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10956may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10957Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10958that is currently in use.
10959
10960Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10961Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10962the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10963@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10964Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10965means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10966the specified entry in the Page Directory.
10967
10968These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10969Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10970controller.
10971
10972These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
10973
10974@cindex physical address from linear address
10975@item info dos address-pte
10976This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10977address. The argument linear address should already have the
10978appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10979accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10980example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10981the variable @code{i} is stored:
10982
10983@smallexample
10984(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i
10985Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:
10986Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30
10987@end smallexample
10988
10989@noindent
10990This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10991whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10992attributes of that page.
10993
10994Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10995since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10996address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10997be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10998declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10999@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11000
11001Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11002transfer buffer:
11003
11004@smallexample
11005(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)
11006Page Table entry for address 0x29110:
11007Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110
11008@end smallexample
11009
11010@noindent
11011(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
110123rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11013this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11014mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11015
11016This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11017@end table
11018
6d2ebf8b 11019@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
11020@section Embedded Operating Systems
11021
11022This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11023embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11024architectures.
11025
11026@menu
11027* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11028@end menu
11029
11030@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11031various real-time operating systems.
11032
6d2ebf8b 11033@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
11034@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11035
11036@cindex VxWorks
11037
11038@table @code
11039
11040@kindex target vxworks
11041@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11042A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11043is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11044
11045@end table
11046
11047On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11048current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11049
11050@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11051VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11052the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11053both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 11054@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 11055installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 11056@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
11057
11058@table @code
11059@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11060@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
11061All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11062This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11063seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11064your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
11065of a thin network line.
11066@end table
11067
11068The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11069this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11070procedures.
11071
11072@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11073To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11074to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11075library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11076VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11077kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11078source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11079information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11080manual.
11081@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11082
11083Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11084your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
11085run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11086@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
11087
11088@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11089
11090@example
11091(vxgdb)
11092@end example
11093
11094@menu
11095* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11096* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11097* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11098@end menu
11099
6d2ebf8b 11100@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
11101@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11102
11103The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11104network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11105
11106@example
11107(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11108@end example
11109
11110@need 750
11111@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11112
11113@smallexample
5d161b24 11114Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
11115Connected to tt.
11116@end smallexample
11117
11118@need 1000
11119@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11120loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11121these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11122path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11123to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11124
11125@example
11126prog.o: No such file or directory.
11127@end example
11128
11129When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11130the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11131command again.
11132
6d2ebf8b 11133@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
11134@subsubsection VxWorks download
11135
11136@cindex download to VxWorks
11137If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11138object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11139@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11140incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11141command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11142to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11143table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11144the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11145filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11146Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11147to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11148the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11149@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11150and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11151program, type this on VxWorks:
11152
11153@example
11154-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11155@end example
d4f3574e
SS
11156
11157@noindent
104c1213
JM
11158Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11159
11160@example
5d161b24 11161(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
11162(vxgdb) load prog.o
11163@end example
11164
11165@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11166
11167@smallexample
11168Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11169@end smallexample
11170
11171You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11172after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11173this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11174auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11175history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 11176debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
11177table.)
11178
6d2ebf8b 11179@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
11180@subsubsection Running tasks
11181
11182@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11183You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11184follows:
11185
11186@example
11187(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11188@end example
11189
11190@noindent
11191where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11192or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11193the time of attachment.
11194
6d2ebf8b 11195@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11196@section Embedded Processors
11197
11198This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11199configurations.
11200
11201@menu
11202* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
11203* ARM:: ARM
11204* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11205* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11206* i960:: Intel i960
11207* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11208* M68K:: Motorola M68K
11209* M88K:: Motorola M88K
11210* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11211* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11212* PowerPC: PowerPC
11213* SH:: Hitachi SH
11214* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11215* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11216* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11217* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11218@end menu
11219
6d2ebf8b 11220@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
11221@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
11222
11223@menu
11224* A29K UDI::
11225* A29K EB29K::
11226* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
11227* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11228* Remote Log:: Remote log
11229@end menu
11230
11231@table @code
11232
11233@kindex target adapt
11234@item target adapt @var{dev}
11235Adapt monitor for A29K.
11236
11237@kindex target amd-eb
11238@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11239@cindex AMD EB29K
11240Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11241@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11242@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11243name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11244@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11245
11246@end table
11247
6d2ebf8b 11248@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
11249@subsubsection A29K UDI
11250
11251@cindex UDI
11252@cindex AMD29K via UDI
11253
11254@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11255protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11256configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11257program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11258use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11259@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11260
11261@table @code
11262@item target udi @var{keyword}
11263@kindex udi
11264Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11265@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11266This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11267connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11268working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11269to its pathname.
11270@end table
11271
6d2ebf8b 11272@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
11273@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11274
11275@cindex EB29K board
11276@cindex running 29K programs
11277
11278AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11279with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11280term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11281@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11282must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11283board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11284assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11285@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11286
6d2ebf8b 11287@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11288@subsubsection Communications setup
11289
11290The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11291in DOS on the PC:
11292
11293@example
11294C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11295@end example
11296
11297@noindent
11298This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11299bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11300you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11301end of the connection as well.
11302@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11303@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11304@c
11305@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11306@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11307@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11308@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11309@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11310
11311To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11312the following at the DOS console:
11313
11314@example
11315C:\> CTTY com1
11316@end example
11317
11318@noindent
11319(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11320the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11321had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11322
11323From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11324@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11325
11326@example
11327cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11328@end example
11329
11330@noindent
11331The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11332serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11333may look something like the following:
11334
11335@example
11336tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11337@end example
11338
11339@noindent
11340Your system may require a different name where we show
11341@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11342parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11343@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11344system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11345@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11346@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11347@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11348@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11349@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11350@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11351@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11352@c
11353@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11354@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11355@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11356
11357@kindex EBMON
11358Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11359directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11360start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11361with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11362@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11363@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11364
11365@example
11366C:\> G:
11367
11368G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11369
11370G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11371Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11372Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11373Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11374
11375Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11376
11377PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11378I/O Base = 0x208
11379Memory Base = 0xd0000
11380
11381Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11382Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11383Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11384
11385PageSize = 0x400
11386Register Stack Size = 0x800
11387Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11388
11389CPU PRL = 0x3
11390Am29027 Available = No
11391Byte Write Available = Yes
11392
11393# ~.
11394@end example
11395
11396Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11397typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11398running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11399
11400For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11401way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11402system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11403PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11404something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11405other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11406from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11407serial line.
11408
6d2ebf8b 11409@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11410@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11411
11412Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11413program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11414name of your 29K program:
11415
11416@example
11417cd /usr/joe/work29k
11418@value{GDBP} myfoo
11419@end example
11420
11421@need 500
11422Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11423
11424@example
11425target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11426@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11427@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11428@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11429@end example
11430
11431@noindent
11432In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11433@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11434@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11435In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11436a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11437the name on the Unix side.
11438
11439At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11440to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11441@code{run}.
11442
11443To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11444command.
11445
11446To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11447once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11448@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11449@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11450Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11451and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11452
6d2ebf8b 11453@node Remote Log
104c1213 11454@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11455@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
11456@cindex log file for EB29K
11457
11458The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11459current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11460@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11461of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11462another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11463unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11464
6d2ebf8b 11465@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11466@subsection ARM
11467
11468@table @code
11469
11470@kindex target rdi
11471@item target rdi @var{dev}
11472ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11473use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11474monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 11475
104c1213
JM
11476@kindex target rdp
11477@item target rdp @var{dev}
11478ARM Demon monitor.
11479
11480@end table
11481
6d2ebf8b 11482@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
11483@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11484
11485@table @code
11486
d4f3574e 11487@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11488@item target hms @var{dev}
11489A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11490Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11491line and the communications speed used.
11492
d4f3574e 11493@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11494@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11495E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11496
d4f3574e
SS
11497@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11498@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 11499@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 11500@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
11501Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11502
11503@end table
11504
11505@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11506@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11507@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11508@cindex Hitachi SH download
11509When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11510board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11511board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11512@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11513
11514@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 11515Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
11516
11517@enumerate
11518@item
11519that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11520for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11521emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 11522the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
11523H8/300, or H8/500.)
11524
11525@item
11526what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11527serial device available on your host is the default).
11528
11529@item
11530what speed to use over the serial device.
11531@end enumerate
11532
11533@menu
11534* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11535* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11536* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11537@end menu
11538
6d2ebf8b 11539@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
11540@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11541
11542@c only for Unix hosts
11543@kindex device
11544@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11545Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
11546need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11547first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11548hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11549
11550@kindex speed
11551@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11552@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 11553speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 11554hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
11555the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11556@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
11557
11558The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11559use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11560use a DOS host,
11561@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11562called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11563through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11564to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11565
11566The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11567program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11568sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11569the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11570
11571First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11572board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11573port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11574When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 11575debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
11576for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11577@code{COM2}.
11578
11579@example
11580C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11581C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11582
11583Resident portion of MODE loaded
11584
11585COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11586
11587@end example
11588
11589@quotation
11590@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11591@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11592disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11593your development board.
11594@end quotation
11595
d4f3574e 11596@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
11597Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11598connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 11599the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
11600you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11601commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11602cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11603download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11604the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11605(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11606executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11607@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11608itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11609
11610@smallexample
11611(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 11612@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 11613 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 11614 the conditions.
5d161b24 11615There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 11616for details.
2df3850c
JM
11617@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11618(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 11619Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 11620(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
11621.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11622.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11623.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11624@end smallexample
11625
11626At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11627you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11628sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11629@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11630resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11631@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11632
11633Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11634available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11635you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11636
11637Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11638@itemize @bullet
11639@item
11640to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11641no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11642
11643@item
11644to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11645normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11646to detect program completion.
11647@end itemize
11648
11649In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11650development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11651
6d2ebf8b 11652@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
11653@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11654
d4f3574e 11655@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
11656You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11657Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11658e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11659
11660@table @code
11661@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11662Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11663@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11664@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11665(for example, @samp{9600}).
11666
11667@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11668If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11669specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11670@end table
11671
6d2ebf8b 11672@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
11673@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11674
11675Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11676
11677@table @code
11678
11679@kindex set machine
11680@kindex show machine
11681@item set machine h8300
11682@itemx set machine h8300h
11683Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11684architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11685to check which variant is currently in effect.
11686
11687@end table
11688
6d2ebf8b 11689@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
11690@subsection H8/500
11691
11692@table @code
11693
11694@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11695@cindex memory models, H8/500
11696@item set memory @var{mod}
11697@itemx show memory
11698Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11699@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11700memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11701@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11702
11703@end table
11704
6d2ebf8b 11705@node i960
104c1213
JM
11706@subsection Intel i960
11707
11708@table @code
11709
11710@kindex target mon960
11711@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11712MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11713
f0ca3dce 11714@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
11715@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11716An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11717the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11718@file{/dev/ttya}.
11719
11720@end table
11721
11722@cindex Nindy
11723@cindex i960
11724@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11725@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11726tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11727
11728@itemize @bullet
11729@item
11730Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11731Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11732
11733@item
11734By responding to a prompt on startup;
11735
11736@item
11737By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11738session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11739
104c1213
JM
11740@end itemize
11741
11742@cindex download to Nindy-960
11743With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11744downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11745@value{GDBN}.
11746
11747@menu
11748* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11749* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11750* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11751@end menu
11752
6d2ebf8b 11753@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
11754@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11755
11756If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11757options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11758reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11759
11760@example
5d161b24 11761Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
11762@end example
11763
11764@noindent
11765Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11766identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11767simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11768with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11769use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11770
6d2ebf8b 11771@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
11772@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11773
11774These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11775Nindy-960 board attached:
11776
11777@table @code
11778@item -r @var{port}
11779Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11780to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11781configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11782@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11783device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11784suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11785
11786@item -O
11787(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11788the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11789This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11790target architecture.
11791
11792@quotation
11793@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11794connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11795fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11796attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11797this process with an interrupt.
11798@end quotation
11799
11800@item -brk
11801Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11802system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11803
11804@quotation
11805@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11806requires; it only works with a few boards.
11807@end quotation
11808@end table
11809
11810The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11811port.
11812
11813@c @group
6d2ebf8b 11814@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
11815@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11816
11817@table @code
11818@item reset
11819@kindex reset
11820For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11821system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11822circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11823a break is detected.
11824@end table
11825@c @end group
11826
6d2ebf8b 11827@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
11828@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11829
11830@table @code
11831
11832@kindex target m32r
11833@item target m32r @var{dev}
11834Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11835
11836@end table
11837
6d2ebf8b 11838@node M68K
104c1213
JM
11839@subsection M68k
11840
11841The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11842target command for the following ROM monitors.
11843
11844@table @code
11845
11846@kindex target abug
11847@item target abug @var{dev}
11848ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11849
11850@kindex target cpu32bug
11851@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11852CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11853
11854@kindex target dbug
11855@item target dbug @var{dev}
11856dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11857
11858@kindex target est
11859@item target est @var{dev}
11860EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11861
11862@kindex target rom68k
11863@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11864ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11865
11866@end table
11867
11868If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11869instead have only a single special target command:
11870
11871@table @code
11872
11873@kindex target es1800
11874@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11875ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11876
11877@end table
11878
11879[context?]
11880
11881@table @code
11882
11883@kindex target rombug
11884@item target rombug @var{dev}
11885ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11886
11887@end table
11888
6d2ebf8b 11889@node M88K
104c1213
JM
11890@subsection M88K
11891
11892@table @code
11893
11894@kindex target bug
11895@item target bug @var{dev}
11896BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11897
11898@end table
11899
6d2ebf8b 11900@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
11901@subsection MIPS Embedded
11902
11903@cindex MIPS boards
11904@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11905MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11906you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11907
11908@need 1000
11909Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11910
11911@table @code
11912@item target mips @var{port}
11913@kindex target mips @var{port}
11914To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11915name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11916command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11917the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11918been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11919download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11920
11921For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11922port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11923debugger:
11924
11925@example
11926host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
11927@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11928(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11929(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11930(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
11931@end example
11932
11933@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11934On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11935connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11936concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11937@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11938
11939@item target pmon @var{port}
11940@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11941PMON ROM monitor.
11942
11943@item target ddb @var{port}
11944@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11945NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11946
11947@item target lsi @var{port}
11948@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11949LSI variant of PMON.
11950
11951@kindex target r3900
11952@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11953Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11954
11955@kindex target array
11956@item target array @var{dev}
11957Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11958
11959@end table
11960
11961
11962@noindent
11963@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11964
11965@table @code
11966@item set processor @var{args}
11967@itemx show processor
11968@kindex set processor @var{args}
11969@kindex show processor
11970Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11971processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11972For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11973to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11974Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11975is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11976@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11977
11978@item set mipsfpu double
11979@itemx set mipsfpu single
11980@itemx set mipsfpu none
11981@itemx show mipsfpu
11982@kindex set mipsfpu
11983@kindex show mipsfpu
11984@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11985@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11986If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11987coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11988need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11989file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11990functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11991@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11992functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11993with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11994processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11995double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11996@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11997
11998In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11999floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12000and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12001
12002As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12003@samp{show mipsfpu}.
12004
12005@item set remotedebug @var{n}
12006@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
12007@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12008@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
12009@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12010@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12011@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12012@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12013You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12014by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12015@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12016to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12017at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12018
12019@item set timeout @var{seconds}
12020@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12021@itemx show timeout
12022@itemx show retransmit-timeout
12023@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12024@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12025@kindex set timeout
12026@kindex show timeout
12027@kindex set retransmit-timeout
12028@kindex show retransmit-timeout
12029You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12030remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12031default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12032waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12033retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12034You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12035retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12036@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12037
12038The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12039is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12040forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12041to run before stopping.
12042@end table
12043
6d2ebf8b 12044@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
12045@subsection PowerPC
12046
12047@table @code
12048
12049@kindex target dink32
12050@item target dink32 @var{dev}
12051DINK32 ROM monitor.
12052
12053@kindex target ppcbug
12054@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12055@kindex target ppcbug1
12056@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12057PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12058
12059@kindex target sds
12060@item target sds @var{dev}
12061SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12062
12063@end table
12064
6d2ebf8b 12065@node PA
104c1213
JM
12066@subsection HP PA Embedded
12067
12068@table @code
12069
12070@kindex target op50n
12071@item target op50n @var{dev}
12072OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12073
12074@kindex target w89k
12075@item target w89k @var{dev}
12076W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12077
12078@end table
12079
6d2ebf8b 12080@node SH
104c1213
JM
12081@subsection Hitachi SH
12082
12083@table @code
12084
d4f3574e 12085@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12086@item target hms @var{dev}
12087A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12088commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12089the communications speed used.
12090
d4f3574e 12091@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12092@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12093E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12094
d4f3574e
SS
12095@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12096@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
12097@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12098@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12099Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12100
12101@end table
12102
6d2ebf8b 12103@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12104@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12105
12106@cindex Sparclet
12107
5d161b24
DB
12108@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12109Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12110@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12111both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 12112@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12113
12114@table @code
f0ca3dce 12115@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 12116@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
12117@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12118This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12119seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12120@end table
12121
41afff9a 12122@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 12123When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 12124information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 12125load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 12126@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
12127
12128@example
12129sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12130@end example
12131
d4f3574e 12132You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
12133
12134@example
12135sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12136@end example
12137
41afff9a 12138@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12139Once you have set
12140your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 12141run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
12142(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12143
12144@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12145
12146@example
12147(gdbslet)
12148@end example
12149
12150@menu
12151* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12152* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12153* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 12154* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12155@end menu
12156
6d2ebf8b 12157@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
12158@subsubsection Setting file to debug
12159
12160The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12161
12162@example
12163(gdbslet) file prog
12164@end example
12165
12166@need 1000
12167@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12168@value{GDBN} locates
12169the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12170path.
12171If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12172files will be searched as well.
12173@value{GDBN} locates
12174the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12175path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12176If it fails
12177to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12178
12179@example
12180prog: No such file or directory.
12181@end example
12182
12183When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 12184the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
12185@code{target} command again.
12186
6d2ebf8b 12187@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
12188@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12189
12190The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12191To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12192
12193@example
12194(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12195Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 12196main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
12197@end example
12198
12199@need 750
12200@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12201
d4f3574e 12202@example
104c1213 12203Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 12204@end example
104c1213 12205
6d2ebf8b 12206@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
12207@subsubsection Sparclet download
12208
12209@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 12210Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
12211you can use the @value{GDBN}
12212@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12213The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12214command.
5d161b24 12215Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 12216address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
12217offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12218of each of the file's sections.
12219For instance, if the program
12220@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12221and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12222
12223@example
12224(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12225Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12226@end example
12227
5d161b24
DB
12228If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12229to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
12230to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12231
6d2ebf8b 12232@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
12233@subsubsection Running and debugging
12234
12235@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12236You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 12237commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
12238manual for the list of commands.
12239
12240@example
12241(gdbslet) b main
12242Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 12243(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
12244Starting program: prog
12245Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
122463 char *symarg = 0;
12247(gdbslet) step
122484 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 12249(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
12250@end example
12251
6d2ebf8b 12252@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12253@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12254
12255@table @code
12256
12257@kindex target sparclite
12258@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
12259Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12260You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12261For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
12262remote protocol.
12263
12264@end table
12265
6d2ebf8b 12266@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
12267@subsection Tandem ST2000
12268
2df3850c 12269@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
12270STDBUG protocol.
12271
12272To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12273manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12274
12275@example
12276target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12277@end example
12278
12279@noindent
12280to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12281the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12282ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12283connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12284concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12285
12286The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12287this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12288would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12289(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12290available on your host computer.
12291@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12292@c basically hearsay.
12293
12294@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12295These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12296environment:
12297
12298@table @code
12299@item st2000 @var{command}
12300@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12301@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12302@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12303Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12304manual for available commands.
12305
12306@item connect
12307@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12308Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12309you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12310sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12311@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12312@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12313@end table
12314
6d2ebf8b 12315@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12316@subsection Zilog Z8000
12317
12318@cindex Z8000
12319@cindex simulator, Z8000
12320@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12321
12322When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12323a Z8000 simulator.
12324
12325For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12326unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12327segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12328appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12329
12330@table @code
12331@item target sim @var{args}
12332@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12333@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12334Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12335options, specify them via @var{args}.
12336@end table
12337
12338@noindent
12339After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12340CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12341@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12342to run your program, and so on.
12343
d4f3574e
SS
12344As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12345(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12346additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12347
12348@table @code
12349
12350@item cycles
12351Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12352
12353@item insts
12354Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12355
12356@item time
12357Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12358
12359@end table
12360
12361You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12362conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12363conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12364simulated clock ticks.
12365
6d2ebf8b 12366@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12367@section Architectures
12368
12369This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12370all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12371
12372@menu
12373* A29K::
12374* Alpha::
12375* MIPS::
12376@end menu
12377
6d2ebf8b 12378@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12379@subsection A29K
12380
12381@table @code
12382
12383@kindex set rstack_high_address
12384@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12385@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12386@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12387On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12388@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12389extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12390stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12391memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12392this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12393the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12394address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12395hexadecimal.
12396
12397@kindex show rstack_high_address
12398@item show rstack_high_address
12399Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12400processors.
12401
12402@end table
12403
6d2ebf8b 12404@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12405@subsection Alpha
12406
12407See the following section.
12408
6d2ebf8b 12409@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12410@subsection MIPS
12411
12412@cindex stack on Alpha
12413@cindex stack on MIPS
12414@cindex Alpha stack
12415@cindex MIPS stack
12416Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12417sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12418find the beginning of a function.
12419
12420@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12421To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12422@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12423you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12424commands:
12425
12426@table @code
00e4a2e4 12427@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12428@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12429Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12430search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12431default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12432larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12433and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12434
12435@item show heuristic-fence-post
12436Display the current limit.
12437@end table
12438
12439@noindent
12440These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12441for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12442
12443
6d2ebf8b 12444@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12445@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12446
53a5351d
JM
12447You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12448@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12449data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12450described here.
c906108c
SS
12451
12452@menu
12453* Prompt:: Prompt
12454* Editing:: Command editing
12455* History:: Command history
12456* Screen Size:: Screen size
12457* Numbers:: Numbers
12458* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 12459* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
12460@end menu
12461
6d2ebf8b 12462@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
12463@section Prompt
12464
12465@cindex prompt
12466
12467@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12468called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12469can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12470instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 12471the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
12472which one you are talking to.
12473
d4f3574e 12474@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
12475prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12476or a prompt that does not.
12477
12478@table @code
12479@kindex set prompt
12480@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12481Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12482
12483@kindex show prompt
12484@item show prompt
12485Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12486@end table
12487
6d2ebf8b 12488@node Editing
c906108c
SS
12489@section Command editing
12490@cindex readline
12491@cindex command line editing
12492
12493@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12494@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12495command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12496or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12497substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12498debugging sessions.
12499
12500You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12501command @code{set}.
12502
12503@table @code
12504@kindex set editing
12505@cindex editing
12506@item set editing
12507@itemx set editing on
12508Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12509
12510@item set editing off
12511Disable command line editing.
12512
12513@kindex show editing
12514@item show editing
12515Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12516@end table
12517
6d2ebf8b 12518@node History
c906108c
SS
12519@section Command history
12520
12521@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12522debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12523happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12524history facility.
12525
12526@table @code
12527@cindex history substitution
12528@cindex history file
12529@kindex set history filename
12530@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12531@item set history filename @var{fname}
12532Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12533This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12534list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12535exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12536the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12537to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
12538@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12539is not set.
c906108c
SS
12540
12541@cindex history save
12542@kindex set history save
12543@item set history save
12544@itemx set history save on
12545Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12546@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12547
12548@item set history save off
12549Stop recording command history in a file.
12550
12551@cindex history size
12552@kindex set history size
12553@item set history size @var{size}
12554Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12555This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12556@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12557@end table
12558
12559@cindex history expansion
12560History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12561@ifset have-readline-appendices
12562@xref{Event Designators}.
12563@end ifset
12564
12565Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12566is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12567@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12568follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12569a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12570history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12571@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12572
12573The commands to control history expansion are:
12574
12575@table @code
12576@kindex set history expansion
12577@item set history expansion on
12578@itemx set history expansion
12579Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12580
12581@item set history expansion off
12582Disable history expansion.
12583
12584The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12585editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12586or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12587@ifset have-readline-appendices
12588@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12589@end ifset
12590
12591@c @group
12592@kindex show history
12593@item show history
12594@itemx show history filename
12595@itemx show history save
12596@itemx show history size
12597@itemx show history expansion
12598These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12599@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12600@c @end group
12601@end table
12602
12603@table @code
41afff9a 12604@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
12605@item show commands
12606Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12607
12608@item show commands @var{n}
12609Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12610
12611@item show commands +
12612Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12613@end table
12614
6d2ebf8b 12615@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
12616@section Screen size
12617@cindex size of screen
12618@cindex pauses in output
12619
12620Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12621information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12622@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12623output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12624to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12625determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12626printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12627rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12628
d4f3574e
SS
12629Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12630driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 12631together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 12632@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
12633you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12634width} commands:
12635
12636@table @code
12637@kindex set height
12638@kindex set width
12639@kindex show width
12640@kindex show height
12641@item set height @var{lpp}
12642@itemx show height
12643@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12644@itemx show width
12645These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12646a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12647commands display the current settings.
12648
5d161b24
DB
12649If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12650output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
12651file or to an editor buffer.
12652
12653Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12654from wrapping its output.
12655@end table
12656
6d2ebf8b 12657@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
12658@section Numbers
12659@cindex number representation
12660@cindex entering numbers
12661
2df3850c
JM
12662You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12663@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12664@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12665begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12666default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12667numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12668change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12669radix} command.
c906108c
SS
12670
12671@table @code
12672@kindex set input-radix
12673@item set input-radix @var{base}
12674Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12675for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12676specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12677example, any of
12678
12679@smallexample
12680set radix 012
12681set radix 10.
12682set radix 0xa
12683@end smallexample
12684
12685@noindent
12686sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12687leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12688
12689@kindex set output-radix
12690@item set output-radix @var{base}
12691Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12692for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12693specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12694
12695@kindex show input-radix
12696@item show input-radix
12697Display the current default base for numeric input.
12698
12699@kindex show output-radix
12700@item show output-radix
12701Display the current default base for numeric display.
12702@end table
12703
6d2ebf8b 12704@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
12705@section Optional warnings and messages
12706
2df3850c
JM
12707By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12708running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12709command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12710internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
12711
12712Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12713which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12714see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12715
12716@table @code
12717@kindex set verbose
12718@item set verbose on
12719Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12720
12721@item set verbose off
12722Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12723
12724@kindex show verbose
12725@item show verbose
12726Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12727@end table
12728
2df3850c
JM
12729By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12730object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12731find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12732symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
12733
12734@table @code
2df3850c 12735
c906108c
SS
12736@kindex set complaints
12737@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
12738Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12739unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12740@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12741to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
12742
12743@kindex show complaints
12744@item show complaints
12745Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 12746
c906108c
SS
12747@end table
12748
12749By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12750lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12751you try to run a program which is already running:
12752
12753@example
12754(@value{GDBP}) run
12755The program being debugged has been started already.
12756Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12757@end example
12758
12759If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12760commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12761
12762@table @code
2df3850c 12763
c906108c
SS
12764@kindex set confirm
12765@cindex flinching
12766@cindex confirmation
12767@cindex stupid questions
12768@item set confirm off
12769Disables confirmation requests.
12770
12771@item set confirm on
12772Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12773
12774@kindex show confirm
12775@item show confirm
12776Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 12777
c906108c
SS
12778@end table
12779
6d2ebf8b 12780@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
12781@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12782@table @code
12783@kindex set debug arch
12784@item set debug arch
12785Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12786@kindex show debug arch
12787@item show debug arch
12788Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12789@kindex set debug event
12790@item set debug event
12791Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12792default is off.
12793@kindex show debug event
12794@item show debug event
12795Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12796info.
12797@kindex set debug expression
12798@item set debug expression
12799Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12800default is off.
12801@kindex show debug expression
12802@item show debug expression
12803Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12804debugging info.
12805@kindex set debug overload
12806@item set debug overload
b37052ae 12807Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
12808info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12809is off.
12810@kindex show debug overload
12811@item show debug overload
b37052ae 12812Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
12813debugging info.
12814@kindex set debug remote
12815@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12816@cindex serial connections, debugging
12817@item set debug remote
12818Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12819the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12820@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12821@kindex show debug remote
12822@item show debug remote
12823Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12824@kindex set debug serial
12825@item set debug serial
12826Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12827default is off.
12828@kindex show debug serial
12829@item show debug serial
12830Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12831info.
12832@kindex set debug target
12833@item set debug target
12834Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12835includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12836default is off.
12837@kindex show debug target
12838@item show debug target
12839Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12840info.
12841@kindex set debug varobj
12842@item set debug varobj
12843Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12844info. The default is off.
12845@kindex show debug varobj
12846@item show debug varobj
12847Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12848debugging info.
12849@end table
12850
6d2ebf8b 12851@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
12852@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12853
12854Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
12855command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12856commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12857files.
c906108c
SS
12858
12859@menu
12860* Define:: User-defined commands
12861* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12862* Command Files:: Command files
12863* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12864@end menu
12865
6d2ebf8b 12866@node Define
c906108c
SS
12867@section User-defined commands
12868
12869@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
12870A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12871which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12872@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12873separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12874via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
12875
12876@smallexample
12877define adder
12878 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12879@end smallexample
12880
d4f3574e
SS
12881@noindent
12882To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
12883
12884@smallexample
12885adder 1 2 3
12886@end smallexample
12887
d4f3574e
SS
12888@noindent
12889This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 12890its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
12891reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12892functions calls.
12893
12894@table @code
2df3850c 12895
c906108c
SS
12896@kindex define
12897@item define @var{commandname}
12898Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12899by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12900
12901The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12902which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12903commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12904
12905@kindex if
12906@kindex else
12907@item if
12908Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12909It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12910only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12911There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12912by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12913was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12914
12915@kindex while
12916@item while
12917The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12918which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12919execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12920The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12921evaluates to true.
12922
12923@kindex document
12924@item document @var{commandname}
12925Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
12926accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12927defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12928reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12929After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
12930@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12931
12932You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12933documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12934does not change the documentation.
12935
12936@kindex help user-defined
12937@item help user-defined
12938List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12939(if any) for each.
12940
12941@kindex show user
12942@item show user
12943@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12944Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12945not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12946definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12947
c906108c
SS
12948@end table
12949
12950When user-defined commands are executed, the
12951commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12952stops execution of the user-defined command.
12953
12954If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12955without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12956commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12957messages when used in a user-defined command.
12958
6d2ebf8b 12959@node Hooks
c906108c 12960@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12961@cindex command hooks
12962@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12963@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12964
c78b4128
EZ
12965@kindex hook
12966@kindex hook-
12967You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12968command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12969command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12970before that command.
12971
c78b4128
EZ
12972@cindex hooks, post-command
12973@kindex hookpost
12974@kindex hookpost-
12975A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12976Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12977@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12978that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12979pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12980
12981It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12982occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12983
12984@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12985@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12986
d4f3574e 12987@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12988In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12989(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12990execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12991displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12992
c906108c
SS
12993For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12994single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12995you could define:
12996
12997@example
12998define hook-stop
12999handle SIGALRM nopass
13000end
13001
13002define hook-run
13003handle SIGALRM pass
13004end
13005
13006define hook-continue
13007handle SIGLARM pass
13008end
13009@end example
c906108c 13010
c78b4128
EZ
13011As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13012command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13013you could define:
13014
13015@example
13016define hook-echo
13017echo <<<---
13018end
13019
13020define hookpost-echo
13021echo --->>>\n
13022end
13023
13024(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13025<<<---Hello World--->>>
13026(@value{GDBP})
13027
13028@end example
13029
c906108c
SS
13030You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13031not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13032name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13033@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13034@c or not?
13035If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13036@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13037(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13038
13039If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13040get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13041
6d2ebf8b 13042@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
13043@section Command files
13044
13045@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
13046A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13047commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13048An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
13049the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13050
13051@cindex init file
13052@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 13053@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 13054When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
13055@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
13056@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
13057following:
13058
13059@enumerate
13060@item
13061Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13062DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13063@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13064
13065@item
13066Processes command line options and operands.
13067
13068@item
13069Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13070
13071@item
13072Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13073@end enumerate
13074
13075The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13076complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13077and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13078option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13079
c906108c
SS
13080@cindex init file name
13081On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13082different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13083form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13084different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13085environments with special init file names:
13086
00e4a2e4 13087@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
13088@itemize @bullet
13089@item
00e4a2e4 13090VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13091
00e4a2e4 13092@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13093@item
00e4a2e4 13094OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13095
00e4a2e4 13096@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13097@item
00e4a2e4 13098ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13099@end itemize
c906108c
SS
13100
13101You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13102@code{source} command:
13103
13104@table @code
13105@kindex source
13106@item source @var{filename}
13107Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13108@end table
13109
13110The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13111printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
13112of the command file.
13113
13114Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13115without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13116normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13117when called from command files.
13118
b433d00b
DH
13119@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13120mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13121standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13122not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13123the next command.
13124
13125@example
13126gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13127@end example
13128
13129(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13130will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13131would be directed to @file{log}.
13132
6d2ebf8b 13133@node Output
c906108c
SS
13134@section Commands for controlled output
13135
13136During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13137@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13138explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13139describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13140want.
13141
13142@table @code
13143@kindex echo
13144@item echo @var{text}
13145@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13146@c because it is not in ANSI.
13147Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13148@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13149newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13150In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13151by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13152string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 13153trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
13154To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13155@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13156
13157A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13158the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13159
13160@example
13161echo This is some text\n\
13162which is continued\n\
13163onto several lines.\n
13164@end example
13165
13166produces the same output as
13167
13168@example
13169echo This is some text\n
13170echo which is continued\n
13171echo onto several lines.\n
13172@end example
13173
13174@kindex output
13175@item output @var{expression}
13176Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13177newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 13178value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
13179on expressions.
13180
13181@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13182Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13183the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13184formats}, for more information.
13185
13186@kindex printf
13187@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13188Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13189@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13190either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13191@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13192subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
13193@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13194@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13195@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13196@c supported.
c906108c
SS
13197
13198@example
13199printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13200@end example
13201
13202For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13203
13204@smallexample
13205printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13206@end smallexample
13207
13208The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13209string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13210letter.
13211@end table
13212
c4555f82
SC
13213@node TUI
13214@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13215@cindex TUI
13216
13217@menu
13218* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13219* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13220* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13221* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13222@end menu
13223
13224The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13225is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13226to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13227and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13228The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13229with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13230
13231@node TUI Overview
13232@section TUI overview
13233
13234The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13235@value{GDBN} runs:
13236
13237@itemize @bullet
13238@item
13239A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13240windows on the terminal.
13241
13242@item
13243A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13244the TUI.
13245@end itemize
13246
13247In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13248on the terminal:
13249
13250@table @emph
13251@item command
13252This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13253prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13254managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13255window is always visible.
13256
13257@item source
13258The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13259line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13260The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
13261active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
13262
13263@item assembly
13264The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13265
13266@item register
13267This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13268a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13269changed are highlighted.
13270
13271@end table
13272
13273The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13274and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13275changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13276These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13277layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13278The following layouts are available:
13279
13280@itemize @bullet
13281@item
13282source
13283
13284@item
13285assembly
13286
13287@item
13288source and assembly
13289
13290@item
13291source and registers
13292
13293@item
13294assembly and registers
13295
13296@end itemize
13297
13298@node TUI Keys
13299@section TUI Key Bindings
13300@cindex TUI key bindings
13301
13302The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13303(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13304They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13305directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
13306are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13307
13308@table @kbd
13309@kindex C-x C-a
13310@item C-x C-a
13311@kindex C-x a
13312@itemx C-x a
13313@kindex C-x A
13314@itemx C-x A
13315Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13316the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13317its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13318mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13319The screen is then refreshed.
13320
13321@kindex C-x 1
13322@item C-x 1
13323Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13324either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13325is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13326
13327Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13328
13329@kindex C-x 2
13330@item C-x 2
13331Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13332layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13333When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13334previous layout and the new one.
13335
13336Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13337
13338@end table
13339
13340The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13341
13342@table @key
13343@kindex PgUp
13344@item PgUp
13345Scroll the active window one page up.
13346
13347@kindex PgDn
13348@item PgDn
13349Scroll the active window one page down.
13350
13351@kindex Up
13352@item Up
13353Scroll the active window one line up.
13354
13355@kindex Down
13356@item Down
13357Scroll the active window one line down.
13358
13359@kindex Left
13360@item Left
13361Scroll the active window one column left.
13362
13363@kindex Right
13364@item Right
13365Scroll the active window one column right.
13366
13367@kindex C-L
13368@item C-L
13369Refresh the screen.
13370
13371@end table
13372
13373In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13374for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13375necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13376@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13377
13378@node TUI Commands
13379@section TUI specific commands
13380@cindex TUI commands
13381
13382The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13383These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13384the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13385is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13386in the TUI mode.
13387
13388@table @code
13389@item layout next
13390@kindex layout next
13391Display the next layout.
13392
13393@item layout prev
13394@kindex layout prev
13395Display the previous layout.
13396
13397@item layout src
13398@kindex layout src
13399Display the source window only.
13400
13401@item layout asm
13402@kindex layout asm
13403Display the assembly window only.
13404
13405@item layout split
13406@kindex layout split
13407Display the source and assembly window.
13408
13409@item layout regs
13410@kindex layout regs
13411Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13412
13413@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13414@kindex focus
13415Set the focus to the named window.
13416This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13417can be affected to another window.
13418
13419@item refresh
13420@kindex refresh
13421Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13422
13423@item update
13424@kindex update
13425Update the source window and the current execution point.
13426
13427@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13428@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13429@kindex winheight
13430Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13431lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13432decrease it.
13433
13434@end table
13435
13436@node TUI Configuration
13437@section TUI configuration variables
13438@cindex TUI configuration variables
13439
13440The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13441appearance of windows on the terminal.
13442
13443@table @code
732b3002
SC
13444@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13445@kindex set tui border-kind
c4555f82
SC
13446Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13447The possible values are the following:
13448@table @code
13449@item space
13450Use a space character to draw the border.
13451
13452@item ascii
13453Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13454
13455@item acs
13456Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13457drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
13458
13459@end table
13460
732b3002
SC
13461@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13462@kindex set tui active-border-mode
c4555f82
SC
13463Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13464The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13465@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
13466
732b3002
SC
13467@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13468@kindex set tui border-mode
c4555f82
SC
13469Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13470The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13471@table @code
13472@item normal
13473Use normal attributes to display the border.
13474
13475@item standout
13476Use standout mode.
13477
13478@item reverse
13479Use reverse video mode.
13480
13481@item half
13482Use half bright mode.
13483
13484@item half-standout
13485Use half bright and standout mode.
13486
13487@item bold
13488Use extra bright or bold mode.
13489
13490@item bold-standout
13491Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
13492
13493@end table
13494
13495@end table
13496
6d2ebf8b 13497@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
13498@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13499
13500@cindex Emacs
13501@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13502A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13503edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13504@value{GDBN}.
13505
13506To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13507executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13508@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13509created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 13510@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
13511
13512Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13513things:
13514
13515@itemize @bullet
13516@item
13517All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13518@end itemize
13519
13520This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13521and output done by the program you are debugging.
13522
13523This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13524commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13525in this way.
13526
13527All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13528with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13529way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13530stop.
13531
13532@itemize @bullet
13533@item
13534@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13535@end itemize
13536
13537Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13538source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13539left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13540source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13541and the source.
13542
13543Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13544usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13545
13546@quotation
13547@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13548current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13549the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13550appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13551environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13552session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13553back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13554avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13555your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13556@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13557
13558A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13559switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13560@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13561@end quotation
13562
13563By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13564you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13565several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13566Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13567
13568@example
13569(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13570@end example
13571
13572@noindent
d4f3574e 13573(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
13574in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13575``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13576
13577In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13578addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13579
13580@table @kbd
13581@item C-h m
13582Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13583
13584@item M-s
13585Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13586update the display window to show the current file and location.
13587
13588@item M-n
13589Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13590calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13591to show the current file and location.
13592
13593@item M-i
13594Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13595display window accordingly.
13596
13597@item M-x gdb-nexti
13598Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13599display window accordingly.
13600
13601@item C-c C-f
13602Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13603@code{finish} command.
13604
13605@item M-c
13606Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13607command.
13608
13609@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13610
13611@item M-u
13612Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13613(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13614like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13615
13616@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13617
13618@item M-d
13619Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13620@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13621
13622@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13623
13624@item C-x &
13625Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13626of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13627around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13628then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13629argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13630
13631You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13632@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13633otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13634inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13635wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13636list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13637formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13638is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13639@end table
13640
13641In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13642tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13643
13644If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13645it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13646request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13647the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13648frame.
13649
13650The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13651which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13652the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13653communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13654delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13655to correspond properly with the code.
13656
13657@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13658@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13659@ignore
13660@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13661@kindex Epoch
13662@kindex inspect
13663
5d161b24 13664Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
13665called the @code{epoch}
13666environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13667@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13668each value is printed in its own window.
13669@end ignore
c906108c 13670
d700128c 13671@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 13672@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 13673
6d2ebf8b 13674@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
13675@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13676@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13677@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13678
13679Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13680
13681Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13682may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13683the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13684reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13685
13686In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13687information that enables us to fix the bug.
13688
13689@menu
13690* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13691* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13692@end menu
13693
6d2ebf8b 13694@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
13695@section Have you found a bug?
13696@cindex bug criteria
13697
13698If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13699
13700@itemize @bullet
13701@cindex fatal signal
13702@cindex debugger crash
13703@cindex crash of debugger
13704@item
13705If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13706@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13707
13708@cindex error on valid input
13709@item
13710If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13711bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13712somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13713
13714@cindex invalid input
13715@item
13716If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13717that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13718``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13719for traditional practice''.
13720
13721@item
13722If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13723for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13724@end itemize
13725
6d2ebf8b 13726@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
13727@section How to report bugs
13728@cindex bug reports
13729@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13730
c906108c
SS
13731A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13732If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13733contact that organization first.
13734
13735You can find contact information for many support companies and
13736individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13737distribution.
13738@c should add a web page ref...
13739
13740In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13741@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13742
13743@example
d4f3574e 13744bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
13745@end example
13746
13747@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 13748@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
13749not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13750@samp{bug-gdb}.
13751
13752The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13753serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13754the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13755newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13756problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13757path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13758we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13759bug reports to the mailing list.
13760
13761As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13762
13763@example
13764@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13765Free Software Foundation Inc.
1376659 Temple Place - Suite 330
13767Boston, MA 02111-1307
13768USA
13769@end example
c906108c
SS
13770
13771The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13772@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13773fact or leave it out, state it!
13774
13775Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13776problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13777assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13778Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13779stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13780name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13781of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13782the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13783easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13784
13785Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13786bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13787you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13788self-contained.
13789
13790Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13791bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13792@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13793bugs properly.
13794
13795To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13796
13797@itemize @bullet
13798@item
13799The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13800with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13801version}.
13802
13803Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13804the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13805
13806@item
13807The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13808version number.
13809
c906108c
SS
13810@item
13811What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13812``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
13813
13814@item
13815What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13816debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13817C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13818information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13819compilers.
13820
13821@item
13822The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13823observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13824you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13825Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13826
13827If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13828and then we might not encounter the bug.
13829
13830@item
13831A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13832reproduce the bug.
13833
13834@item
13835A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13836incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13837
13838Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13839will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13840not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13841a chance to make a mistake.
13842
13843Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13844say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13845copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13846the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13847crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13848ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13849us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13850to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13851
c906108c
SS
13852@item
13853If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13854diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13855it by context, not by line number.
13856
13857The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13858sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 13859
c906108c
SS
13860@end itemize
13861
13862Here are some things that are not necessary:
13863
13864@itemize @bullet
13865@item
13866A description of the envelope of the bug.
13867
13868Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13869which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13870changes will not affect it.
13871
13872This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13873will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13874with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13875We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13876
13877Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13878of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13879output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13880less time, and so on.
13881
13882However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13883report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13884
13885@item
13886A patch for the bug.
13887
13888A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13889the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13890a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13891to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13892
13893Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13894construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13895through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13896to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13897
13898And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13899patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13900help us to understand.
13901
13902@item
13903A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13904
13905Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13906things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13907@end itemize
13908
5d161b24 13909@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
13910@c and consists of the two following files:
13911@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13912@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13913@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13914@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13915@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13916@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13917
13918
6d2ebf8b 13919@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
13920@appendix Formatting Documentation
13921
13922@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13923@cindex reference card
13924The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13925for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13926subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13927@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13928release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13929you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13930
13931The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13932can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13933
13934@example
13935make refcard.dvi
13936@end example
13937
5d161b24
DB
13938The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13939mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
13940that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13941high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13942your @sc{dvi} output program.
13943
13944@cindex documentation
13945
13946All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13947distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13948a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13949on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13950formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13951and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13952
13953@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13954version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13955file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13956subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13957necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13958but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13959Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13960@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13961
13962If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13963Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13964@code{makeinfo}.
13965
13966If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13967@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13968version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13969
13970@example
13971cd gdb
13972make gdb.info
13973@end example
13974
13975If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13976a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13977Texinfo definitions file.
13978
13979@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13980produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13981document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13982has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13983command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13984(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13985require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13986
13987@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13988@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13989written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13990typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13991and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13992directory.
13993
13994If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13995typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13996subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13997@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13998
13999@example
14000make gdb.dvi
14001@end example
14002
14003Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 14004
6d2ebf8b 14005@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
14006@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14007@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14008@cindex installation
14009
c906108c
SS
14010@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14011of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14012build the @code{gdb} program.
14013@iftex
14014@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14015@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14016look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14017installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14018@end iftex
14019
5d161b24
DB
14020The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14021@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
14022appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
14023
14024For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14025@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
14026
14027@table @code
14028@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14029script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
14030
14031@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14032the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
14033
14034@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14035source for the Binary File Descriptor library
14036
14037@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14038@sc{gnu} include files
14039
14040@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14041source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
14042
14043@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14044source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
14045
14046@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14047source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
14048
14049@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14050source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
14051
14052@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14053source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14054@end table
14055
14056The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14057from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14058this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
14059
14060First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14061if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14062identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14063argument.
14064
14065For example:
14066
14067@example
14068cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14069./configure @var{host}
14070make
14071@end example
14072
14073@noindent
14074where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14075@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14076(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14077correct value by examining your system.)
14078
14079Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14080@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14081libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14082binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
14083
14084@need 750
14085@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14086system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14087shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
14088
14089@example
14090sh configure @var{host}
14091@end example
14092
14093If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14094directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14095@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14096creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14097you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14098
14099You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14100subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14101configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
14102
14103For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14104the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
14105
14106@example
14107@group
14108cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14109../configure @var{host}
14110@end group
14111@end example
14112
14113You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14114However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14115the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14116that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14117let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
14118
14119@menu
14120* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14121* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14122* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14123@end menu
14124
6d2ebf8b 14125@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
14126@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14127
14128If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14129you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14130host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14131allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14132rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14133handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14134@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14135program specified there.
14136
14137To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14138with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14139(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14140itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14141would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14142the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
14143
5d161b24 14144For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
14145separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
14146
14147@example
14148@group
14149cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14150mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14151cd ../gdb-sun4
14152../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14153make
14154@end group
14155@end example
14156
14157When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14158directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14159(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14160the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14161directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14162@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
14163
14164One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
14165directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14166@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14167programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
14168You specify a cross-debugging target by
14169giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
14170
14171When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14172it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14173called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
14174
14175The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14176directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14177directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14178directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14179will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
14180
14181When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14182directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14183if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14184with each other.
14185
6d2ebf8b 14186@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
14187@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
14188
14189The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14190script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14191aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14192of information in the following pattern:
14193
14194@example
14195@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
14196@end example
14197
14198For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14199or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14200option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
14201
14202The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14203any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14204aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14205@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14206script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14207abbreviations---for example:
14208
14209@smallexample
14210% sh config.sub i386-linux
14211i386-pc-linux-gnu
14212% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14213alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14214% sh config.sub hp9k700
14215hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14216% sh config.sub sun4
14217sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14218% sh config.sub sun3
14219m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14220% sh config.sub i986v
14221Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14222@end smallexample
14223
14224@noindent
14225@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14226directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
14227
6d2ebf8b 14228@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
14229@section @code{configure} options
14230
14231Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14232are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14233several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14234Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
14235
14236@example
14237configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14238 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14239 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14240 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14241 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14242 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14243 @var{host}
14244@end example
14245
14246@noindent
14247You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14248@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14249@samp{--}.
14250
14251@table @code
14252@item --help
14253Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
14254
14255@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14256Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14257@file{@var{dir}}.
14258
14259@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14260Configure the source to install programs under directory
14261@file{@var{dir}}.
14262
14263@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14264@need 2000
14265@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14266@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14267@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14268Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14269@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14270build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14271directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14272the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14273directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14274the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14275@var{dirname}.
14276
14277@item --norecursion
14278Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14279propagate configuration to subdirectories.
14280
14281@item --target=@var{target}
14282Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14283@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14284programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
14285
14286There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
14287
14288@item @var{host} @dots{}
14289Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
14290
14291There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14292@end table
14293
14294There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14295needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 14296
6d2ebf8b 14297@node Index
c906108c
SS
14298@unnumbered Index
14299
14300@printindex cp
14301
14302@tex
14303% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
14304% meantime:
14305\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
14306\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
14307\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
14308\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
14309\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
14310\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
14311\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
14312\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
14313\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
14314\page\colophon
14315% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
14316@end tex
14317
449f3b6c
AC
14318@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
14319@ifinfo
c906108c 14320@contents
449f3b6c
AC
14321@end ifinfo
14322@ifhtml
14323@contents
14324@end ifhtml
14325
c906108c 14326@bye
This page took 0.79261 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.